2001-11-26 Fernando Nasser <fnasser@redhat.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518
KB
2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
e9c75b65 34@set DATE April 2001
c906108c 35
6d2ebf8b 36@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
c906108c 37
c906108c 38@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 39@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
40@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41@direntry
c906108c 42* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
43@end direntry
44
c906108c
SS
45@ifinfo
46This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
5d161b24 49This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
50of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
e9c75b65
EZ
53Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
54 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 55
e9c75b65
EZ
56Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
59Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
60Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
61with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 62
e9c75b65
EZ
63(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
64this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
65Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
66@end ifinfo
67
68@titlepage
69@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
70@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 71@sp 1
c906108c
SS
72@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
73@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 74@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 75@page
c906108c
SS
76@tex
77{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 78\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
79\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
80\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
81}
82@end tex
53a5351d 83
c906108c 84@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
e9c75b65
EZ
85Copyright @copyright{} 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
86 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 87@sp 2
c906108c
SS
88Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
8959 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
90Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 91ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
92
93Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
94under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
95any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
96Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
97Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
98with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
99
100(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
101this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
102Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
103@end titlepage
104@page
105
b9deaee7 106@ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
107@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
c906108c
SS
109@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
111This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
5d161b24 113This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
114@value{GDBVN}.
115
e9c75b65 116Copyright (C) 1988-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
117
118@menu
119* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
120* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
121
122* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
123* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
124* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
125* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
126* Stack:: Examining the stack
127* Source:: Examining source files
128* Data:: Examining data
b37052ae 129* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
6d2ebf8b
SS
130
131* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
132
133* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
134* Altering:: Altering execution
135* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
136* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
137* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
138* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
139* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 140* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
141* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
142* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 143* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
144
145* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
146* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
147
148* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
149* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
150* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
151* Index:: Index
152@end menu
153
b9deaee7 154@end ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
155
156@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
157
158@ifhtml
159@node Top
160
161@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
162
163This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
164
b37052ae 165This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
6d2ebf8b
SS
166@value{GDBVN}.
167
168Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
169
c906108c
SS
170@menu
171* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 172* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
173
174* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
175* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
176* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
177* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
178* Stack:: Examining the stack
179* Source:: Examining source files
180* Data:: Examining data
496e6bc3 181* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
c906108c 182
7a292a7a 183* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
184
185* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
186* Altering:: Altering execution
187* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
188* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 189* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
190* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
191* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
496e6bc3 192* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
c906108c 193* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6d2ebf8b 194* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
496e6bc3 195* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
c906108c
SS
196
197* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 198* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
199
200* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
201* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
202* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
203* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
204@end menu
205
6d2ebf8b
SS
206@end ifhtml
207
449f3b6c
AC
208@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
209@iftex
210@contents
211@end iftex
212
6d2ebf8b 213@node Summary
c906108c
SS
214@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
215
216The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
217going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
218program was doing at the moment it crashed.
219
220@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
221these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
222
223@itemize @bullet
224@item
225Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
226
227@item
228Make your program stop on specified conditions.
229
230@item
231Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
232
233@item
234Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
235effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
236@end itemize
237
cce74817 238You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 239For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
240For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
241
cce74817
JM
242@cindex Chill
243@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 244Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 245see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 246
cce74817
JM
247@cindex Pascal
248Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
249nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
250entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
251syntax.
c906108c 252
c906108c
SS
253@cindex Fortran
254@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 255it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 256underscore.
c906108c 257
c906108c
SS
258@menu
259* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
260* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
261@end menu
262
6d2ebf8b 263@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
264@unnumberedsec Free software
265
5d161b24 266@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
267General Public License
268(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
269program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
270freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
271the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
272Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
273Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
274
275Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
276you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
277from anyone else.
278
6d2ebf8b 279@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
280@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
281
282Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
283other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
284development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
285of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
286to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
287file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
288blow-by-blow account.
289
290Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
291
292@quotation
293@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
294or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
295omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
296@end quotation
297
298So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
299particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
300releases:
b37052ae 301Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
c906108c
SS
302Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
303Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
304Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
305Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
306Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
307John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
308Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
309and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
310
311Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
312Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
313
b37052ae
EZ
314Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
315in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
316Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
317demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
318much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 319
b37052ae 320@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
321object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
322Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
323
324David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
325the original support for encapsulated COFF.
326
96c405b3 327Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
328
329Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
330Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
331support.
332Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
333Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
334Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
335David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
336Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
337Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
338Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
339Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
340Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
341Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
342Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
343Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
344Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
345Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
346Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
347
348Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
349
350Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
351libraries.
352
353Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
354about several machine instruction sets.
355
356Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
357remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
358contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
359and RDI targets, respectively.
360
361Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
362command-line editing and command history.
363
7a292a7a
SS
364Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
365Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 366
5d161b24 367Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 368He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 369symbols.
c906108c
SS
370
371Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
372Super-H processors.
373
374NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
375
376Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
377
378Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
379
380Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
381
96a2c332 382Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
383
384Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
385watchpoints.
386
387Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
388
389Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
390
391Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 392nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
393
394The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
395support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 396(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
397compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
398John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
399Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
400information in this manual.
401
b37052ae
EZ
402DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
403Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
404
96a2c332
SS
405Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
406development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
407fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
408Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
409Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
410Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
411Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
412addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
413JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
414Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
415Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
416Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
417Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
418Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
419Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
420
421
6d2ebf8b 422@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
423@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
424
425You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
426However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
427debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
428
429@iftex
430In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
431to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
432@end iftex
433
434@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
435@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
436
437One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
438processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
439quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
440definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
441session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
442then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
443same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
444@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
445procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
446
447@smallexample
448$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
449$ @b{./m4}
450@b{define(foo,0000)}
451
452@b{foo}
4530000
454@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
455
456@b{bar}
4570000
458@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
459
460@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
461@b{baz}
462@b{C-d}
463m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
464@end smallexample
465
466@noindent
467Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
468
c906108c
SS
469@smallexample
470$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
471@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
472@c FIXME... format to come out better.
473@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 474 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 475 the conditions.
5d161b24 476There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
477 for details.
478
479@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
480(@value{GDBP})
481@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
482
483@noindent
484@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
485rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
486We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
487that examples fit in this manual.
488
489@smallexample
490(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
491@end smallexample
492
493@noindent
494We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
495Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
496@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
497@code{break} command.
498
499@smallexample
500(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
501Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
502@end smallexample
503
504@noindent
505Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
506control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
507subroutine, the program runs as usual:
508
509@smallexample
510(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
511Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
512@b{define(foo,0000)}
513
514@b{foo}
5150000
516@end smallexample
517
518@noindent
519To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
520suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
521context where it stops.
522
523@smallexample
524@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
525
5d161b24 526Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
527 at builtin.c:879
528879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
529@end smallexample
530
531@noindent
532Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
533the next line of the current function.
534
535@smallexample
536(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
537882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
538 : nil,
539@end smallexample
540
541@noindent
542@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
543by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
544@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
545subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
546
547@smallexample
548(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
549set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
550 at input.c:530
551530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
552@end smallexample
553
554@noindent
555The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
556suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
557shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
558command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
559in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
560stack frame for each active subroutine.
561
562@smallexample
563(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
564#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
565 at input.c:530
5d161b24 566#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
567 at builtin.c:882
568#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
569#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
570 at macro.c:71
571#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
572#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
573@end smallexample
574
575@noindent
576We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
577times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
578falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
579
580@smallexample
581(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5820x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
583(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5840x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
585def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
586(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
587536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
588 : xstrdup(rq);
589(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
590538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
591@end smallexample
592
593@noindent
594The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
595@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
596and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
597(@code{print}) to see their values.
598
599@smallexample
600(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
601$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
602(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
603$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
604@end smallexample
605
606@noindent
607@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
608To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
609surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
610
611@smallexample
612(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
613533 xfree(rquote);
614534
615535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
616 : xstrdup (lq);
617536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
618 : xstrdup (rq);
619537
620538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
621539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
622540 @}
623541
624542 void
625@end smallexample
626
627@noindent
628Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
629@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
630
631@smallexample
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
633539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
635540 @}
636(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
637$3 = 9
638(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
639$4 = 7
640@end smallexample
641
642@noindent
643That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
644@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
645@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
646the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
647any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
648assignments.
649
650@smallexample
651(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
652$5 = 7
653(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
654$6 = 9
655@end smallexample
656
657@noindent
658Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
659@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
660executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
661example that caused trouble initially:
662
663@smallexample
664(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
665Continuing.
666
667@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
668
669baz
6700000
671@end smallexample
672
673@noindent
674Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
675problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
676lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
677
678@smallexample
679@b{C-d}
680Program exited normally.
681@end smallexample
682
683@noindent
684The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
685indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
686session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
687
688@smallexample
689(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
690@end smallexample
c906108c 691
6d2ebf8b 692@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
693@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
694
695This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 696The essentials are:
c906108c 697@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 698@item
53a5351d 699type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 700@item
c906108c
SS
701type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
702@end itemize
703
704@menu
705* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
706* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
707* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
708@end menu
709
6d2ebf8b 710@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
711@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
712
c906108c
SS
713Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
714@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
715
716You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
717to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
718
c906108c
SS
719The command-line options described here are designed
720to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 721options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
722
723The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
724specifying an executable program:
725
726@example
727@value{GDBP} @var{program}
728@end example
729
c906108c
SS
730@noindent
731You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
732specified:
733
734@example
735@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
736@end example
737
738You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
739to debug a running process:
740
741@example
742@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
743@end example
744
745@noindent
746would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
747named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
748
c906108c 749Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
750complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
751debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
752``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
753will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 754
aa26fa3a
TT
755You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
756executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
757option processing.
758@example
759gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
760@end example
761This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
762@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
763
96a2c332 764You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
765@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
766
767@smallexample
768@value{GDBP} -silent
769@end smallexample
770
771@noindent
772You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
773options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
774
775@noindent
776Type
777
778@example
779@value{GDBP} -help
780@end example
781
782@noindent
783to display all available options and briefly describe their use
784(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
785
786All options and command line arguments you give are processed
787in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
788@samp{-x} option is used.
789
790
791@menu
c906108c
SS
792* File Options:: Choosing files
793* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
794@end menu
795
6d2ebf8b 796@node File Options
c906108c
SS
797@subsection Choosing files
798
2df3850c 799When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
800specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
801the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
802@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
803that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
804@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
805that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
806the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
807
808If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
809such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
810argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
811
812Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
813following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
814them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
815(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
816than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
817
d700128c
EZ
818@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
819@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
820@c it.
821
c906108c
SS
822@table @code
823@item -symbols @var{file}
824@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
825@cindex @code{--symbols}
826@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
827Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
828
829@item -exec @var{file}
830@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
831@cindex @code{--exec}
832@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
833Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
834and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
835
836@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 837@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
838Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
839file.
840
c906108c
SS
841@item -core @var{file}
842@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
843@cindex @code{--core}
844@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
845Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
846
847@item -c @var{number}
848Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
849(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
850case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
851
852@item -command @var{file}
853@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
854@cindex @code{--command}
855@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
856Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
857Files,, Command files}.
858
859@item -directory @var{directory}
860@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
861@cindex @code{--directory}
862@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
863Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
864
c906108c
SS
865@item -m
866@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
867@cindex @code{--mapped}
868@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
869@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
870supported on all systems.}@*
871If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 872system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
873to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
874program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 875called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
876Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
877and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
878the symbol table from the executable program.
879
880The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
881is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
882table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 883
c906108c
SS
884@item -r
885@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
886@cindex @code{--readnow}
887@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
888Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
889the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
890This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 891
c906108c
SS
892@end table
893
2df3850c 894You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 895order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
896information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
897on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
898but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
899
900@example
2df3850c 901gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 902@end example
c906108c 903
6d2ebf8b 904@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
905@subsection Choosing modes
906
907You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
908batch mode or quiet mode.
909
910@table @code
911@item -nx
912@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
913@cindex @code{--nx}
914@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c 915Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
2a3d5645 916called @file{.gdbinit} or @file{gdb.ini} under MS-DOS). Normally,
2df3850c
JM
917@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
918options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
919files}.
c906108c
SS
920
921@item -quiet
d700128c 922@itemx -silent
c906108c 923@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
924@cindex @code{--quiet}
925@cindex @code{--silent}
926@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
927``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
928messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
929
930@item -batch
d700128c 931@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
932Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
933command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
934initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
935nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
936in the command files.
937
2df3850c
JM
938Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
939example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
940make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
941
942@example
943Program exited normally.
944@end example
945
946@noindent
2df3850c
JM
947(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
948@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
949mode.
950
951@item -nowindows
952@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
953@cindex @code{--nowindows}
954@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 955``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 956(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
957interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
958
959@item -windows
960@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
961@cindex @code{--windows}
962@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
963If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
964used if possible.
c906108c
SS
965
966@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 967@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
968Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
969instead of the current directory.
970
c906108c
SS
971@item -fullname
972@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
973@cindex @code{--fullname}
974@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
975@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
976subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
977number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
978displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
979recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
980the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
981and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
982@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
983frame.
c906108c 984
d700128c
EZ
985@item -epoch
986@cindex @code{--epoch}
987The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
988@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
989routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
990separate window.
991
992@item -annotate @var{level}
993@cindex @code{--annotate}
994This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
995effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
996(@pxref{Annotations}).
997Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
998together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
999types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1000@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1001maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1002
1003@item -async
1004@cindex @code{--async}
1005Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1006@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1007special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1008commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1009run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1010MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1011suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1012control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1013(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1014operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1015yet.)
1016@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1017@c should be removed.
1018
1019When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1020uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1021@samp{-noasync} option.
1022
1023@item -noasync
1024@cindex @code{--noasync}
1025Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1026
aa26fa3a
TT
1027@item --args
1028@cindex @code{--args}
1029Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1030executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1031This option stops option processing.
1032
2df3850c
JM
1033@item -baud @var{bps}
1034@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1035@cindex @code{--baud}
1036@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1037Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1038interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1039
1040@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1041@itemx -t @var{device}
1042@cindex @code{--tty}
1043@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1044Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1045@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1046
53a5351d 1047@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1048@item -tui
1049@cindex @code{--tui}
1050Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1051The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1052showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1053(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1054Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1055(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1056
1057@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1058@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1059@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1060@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1061@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1062@c systems.
1063
d700128c
EZ
1064@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1065@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1066Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1067program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1068communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1069
1070@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1071@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1072@sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1073@value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
d700128c
EZ
1074
1075@item -write
1076@cindex @code{--write}
1077Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1078is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1079(@pxref{Patching}).
1080
1081@item -statistics
1082@cindex @code{--statistics}
1083This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1084memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1085
1086@item -version
1087@cindex @code{--version}
1088This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1089no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1090
c906108c
SS
1091@end table
1092
6d2ebf8b 1093@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1094@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1095@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1096@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1097
1098@table @code
1099@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1100@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1101@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1102@itemx q
1103To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1104@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1105do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1106otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1107error code.
c906108c
SS
1108@end table
1109
1110@cindex interrupt
1111An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1112terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1113returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1114character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1115until a time when it is safe.
1116
c906108c
SS
1117If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1118device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1119(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1120
6d2ebf8b 1121@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1122@section Shell commands
1123
1124If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1125debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1126just use the @code{shell} command.
1127
1128@table @code
1129@kindex shell
1130@cindex shell escape
1131@item shell @var{command string}
1132Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1133If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1134shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1135(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1136@end table
1137
1138The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1139You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1140@value{GDBN}:
1141
1142@table @code
1143@kindex make
1144@cindex calling make
1145@item make @var{make-args}
1146Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1147arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1148@end table
1149
6d2ebf8b 1150@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1151@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1152
1153You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1154name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1155@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1156key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1157show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1158
1159@menu
1160* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1161* Completion:: Command completion
1162* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1163@end menu
1164
6d2ebf8b 1165@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1166@section Command syntax
1167
1168A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1169how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1170arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1171command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1172step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1173with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1174
1175@cindex abbreviation
1176@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1177unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1178documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1179abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1180equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1181names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1182arguments to the @code{help} command.
1183
1184@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1185@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1186A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1187repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1188will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1189repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1190repeat.
1191
1192The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1193@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1194exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1195
1196@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1197output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1198(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1199@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1200repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1201
41afff9a 1202@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1203@cindex comment
1204Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1205nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1206Files,,Command files}).
1207
6d2ebf8b 1208@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1209@section Command completion
1210
1211@cindex completion
1212@cindex word completion
1213@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1214only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1215are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1216commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1217
1218Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1219of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1220word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1221enter it). For example, if you type
1222
1223@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1224@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1225@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1226@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1227@example
1228(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1229@end example
1230
1231@noindent
1232@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1233the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1234
1235@example
1236(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1237@end example
1238
1239@noindent
1240You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1241breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1242@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1243were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1244might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1245to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1246
1247If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1248@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1249characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1250@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1251example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1252begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1253just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1254function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1255example:
1256
1257@example
1258(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1259@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1260make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1261make_abs_section make_function_type
1262make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1263make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1264make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1265(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1266@end example
1267
1268@noindent
1269After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1270partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1271command.
1272
1273If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1274can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1275means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1276key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1277one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1278
1279@cindex quotes in commands
1280@cindex completion of quoted strings
1281Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1282parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1283its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1284situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1285@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1286
c906108c 1287The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1288name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1289overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1290by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1291may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1292that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1293that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1294word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1295@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1296@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1297when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c
SS
1298
1299@example
96a2c332 1300(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1301bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1302(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1303@end example
1304
1305In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1306quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1307completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1308place:
1309
1310@example
1311(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1312@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1313(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1314@end example
1315
1316@noindent
1317In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1318you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1319completion on an overloaded symbol.
1320
d4f3574e 1321For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1322expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1323overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1324see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1325
1326
6d2ebf8b 1327@node Help
c906108c
SS
1328@section Getting help
1329@cindex online documentation
1330@kindex help
1331
5d161b24 1332You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1333using the command @code{help}.
1334
1335@table @code
41afff9a 1336@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1337@item help
1338@itemx h
1339You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1340display a short list of named classes of commands:
1341
1342@smallexample
1343(@value{GDBP}) help
1344List of classes of commands:
1345
2df3850c 1346aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1347breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1348data -- Examining data
c906108c 1349files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1350internals -- Maintenance commands
1351obscure -- Obscure features
1352running -- Running the program
1353stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1354status -- Status inquiries
1355support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1356tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1357 stopping the program
c906108c 1358user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1359
5d161b24 1360Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1361commands in that class.
5d161b24 1362Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1363documentation.
1364Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1365(@value{GDBP})
1366@end smallexample
96a2c332 1367@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1368
1369@item help @var{class}
1370Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1371list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1372help display for the class @code{status}:
1373
1374@smallexample
1375(@value{GDBP}) help status
1376Status inquiries.
1377
1378List of commands:
1379
1380@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1381@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1382info -- Generic command for showing things
1383 about the program being debugged
1384show -- Generic command for showing things
1385 about the debugger
c906108c 1386
5d161b24 1387Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1388documentation.
1389Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1390(@value{GDBP})
1391@end smallexample
1392
1393@item help @var{command}
1394With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1395short paragraph on how to use that command.
1396
6837a0a2
DB
1397@kindex apropos
1398@item apropos @var{args}
1399The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1400commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1401@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1402
1403@smallexample
1404apropos reload
1405@end smallexample
1406
b37052ae
EZ
1407@noindent
1408results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1409
1410@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1411@c @group
1412set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1413 multiple times in one run
1414show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1415 multiple times in one run
1416@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1417@end smallexample
1418
c906108c
SS
1419@kindex complete
1420@item complete @var{args}
1421The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1422for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1423command you want completed. For example:
1424
1425@smallexample
1426complete i
1427@end smallexample
1428
1429@noindent results in:
1430
1431@smallexample
1432@group
2df3850c
JM
1433if
1434ignore
c906108c
SS
1435info
1436inspect
c906108c
SS
1437@end group
1438@end smallexample
1439
1440@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1441@end table
1442
1443In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1444and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1445of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1446manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1447under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1448all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1449
1450@c @group
1451@table @code
1452@kindex info
41afff9a 1453@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1454@item info
1455This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1456program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1457with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1458registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1459You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1460@w{@code{help info}}.
1461
1462@kindex set
1463@item set
5d161b24 1464You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1465@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1466@code{set prompt $}.
1467
1468@kindex show
1469@item show
5d161b24 1470In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1471@value{GDBN} itself.
1472You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1473related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1474system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1475which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1476
1477@kindex info set
1478To display all the settable parameters and their current
1479values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1480@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1481@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1482@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1483@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1484@end table
1485@c @end group
1486
1487Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1488exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1489
1490@table @code
1491@kindex show version
1492@cindex version number
1493@item show version
1494Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1495information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1496@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1497version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1498commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1499system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1500variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1501The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1502@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1503
1504@kindex show copying
1505@item show copying
1506Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1507
1508@kindex show warranty
1509@item show warranty
2df3850c 1510Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1511if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1512
c906108c
SS
1513@end table
1514
6d2ebf8b 1515@node Running
c906108c
SS
1516@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1517
1518When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1519debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1520
1521You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1522of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1523your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1524kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1525
1526@menu
1527* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1528* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1529* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1530* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1531
1532* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1533* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1534* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1535* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1536
1537* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1538* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1539@end menu
1540
6d2ebf8b 1541@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1542@section Compiling for debugging
1543
1544In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1545debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1546is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1547variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1548and addresses in the executable code.
1549
1550To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1551the compiler.
1552
1553Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1554options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1555executables containing debugging information.
1556
53a5351d
JM
1557@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1558without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1559recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1560program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1561in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1562
1563@cindex optimized code, debugging
1564@cindex debugging optimized code
1565When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1566optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1567really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1568exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1569variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1570variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1571
1572Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1573@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1574doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1575please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1576
1577Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1578@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1579format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1580
1581@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1582@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1583@section Starting your program
1584@cindex starting
1585@cindex running
1586
1587@table @code
1588@kindex run
41afff9a 1589@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1590@item run
1591@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1592Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1593You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1594argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1595@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1596(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1597
1598@end table
1599
c906108c
SS
1600If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1601supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1602that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1603@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1604
1605The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1606receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1607information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1608can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1609your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1610divided into four categories:
1611
1612@table @asis
1613@item The @emph{arguments.}
1614Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1615@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1616is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1617(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1618the arguments.
1619In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1620@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1621@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1622
1623@item The @emph{environment.}
1624Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1625use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1626environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1627your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1628
1629@item The @emph{working directory.}
1630Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1631the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1632@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1633
1634@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1635Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1636standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1637in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1638set a different device for your program.
1639@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1640
1641@cindex pipes
1642@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1643pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1644program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1645wrong program.
1646@end table
c906108c
SS
1647
1648When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1649immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1650of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1651stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1652or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1653
1654If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1655time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1656table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1657your current breakpoints.
1658
6d2ebf8b 1659@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1660@section Your program's arguments
1661
1662@cindex arguments (to your program)
1663The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1664@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1665They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1666performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1667@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1668@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1669the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1670
1671On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1672@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1673calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1674the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1675
1676@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1677@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1678
c906108c 1679@table @code
41afff9a 1680@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1681@item set args
1682Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1683@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1684with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1685using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1686it again without arguments.
1687
1688@kindex show args
1689@item show args
1690Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1691@end table
1692
6d2ebf8b 1693@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1694@section Your program's environment
1695
1696@cindex environment (of your program)
1697The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1698their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1699your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1700path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1701the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1702debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1703environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1704
1705@table @code
1706@kindex path
1707@item path @var{directory}
1708Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1709(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1710The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1711You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1712system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1713MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1714is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1715
1716You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1717working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1718use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1719@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1720@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1721@var{directory} to the search path.
1722@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1723@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1724
1725@kindex show paths
1726@item show paths
1727Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1728environment variable).
1729
1730@kindex show environment
1731@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1732Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1733your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1734print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1735your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1736
1737@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1738@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1739Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1740changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1741be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1742any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1743parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1744null value.
1745@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1746@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1747
1748For example, this command:
1749
1750@example
1751set env USER = foo
1752@end example
1753
1754@noindent
d4f3574e 1755tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1756@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1757are not actually required.)
1758
1759@kindex unset environment
1760@item unset environment @var{varname}
1761Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1762program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1763@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1764rather than assigning it an empty value.
1765@end table
1766
d4f3574e
SS
1767@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1768the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1769by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1770@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1771that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1772@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1773your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1774files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1775@file{.profile}.
1776
6d2ebf8b 1777@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1778@section Your program's working directory
1779
1780@cindex working directory (of your program)
1781Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1782working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1783The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1784from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1785working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1786
1787The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1788that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1789specify files}.
1790
1791@table @code
1792@kindex cd
1793@item cd @var{directory}
1794Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1795
1796@kindex pwd
1797@item pwd
1798Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1799@end table
1800
6d2ebf8b 1801@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1802@section Your program's input and output
1803
1804@cindex redirection
1805@cindex i/o
1806@cindex terminal
1807By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1808the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1809to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1810modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1811running your program.
1812
1813@table @code
1814@kindex info terminal
1815@item info terminal
1816Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1817program is using.
1818@end table
1819
1820You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1821redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1822
1823@example
1824run > outfile
1825@end example
1826
1827@noindent
1828starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1829
1830@kindex tty
1831@cindex controlling terminal
1832Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1833with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1834argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1835commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1836process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1837
1838@example
1839tty /dev/ttyb
1840@end example
1841
1842@noindent
1843directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1844default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1845that as their controlling terminal.
1846
1847An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1848effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1849terminal.
1850
1851When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1852command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1853for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1854
6d2ebf8b 1855@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1856@section Debugging an already-running process
1857@kindex attach
1858@cindex attach
1859
1860@table @code
1861@item attach @var{process-id}
1862This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1863outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1864targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1865find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1866or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1867
1868@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1869executing the command.
1870@end table
1871
1872To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1873which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1874programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1875also have permission to send the process a signal.
1876
1877When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1878the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1879the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1880(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1881the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1882Specify Files}.
1883
1884The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1885process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1886with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1887you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1888can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1889process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1890attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1891
1892@table @code
1893@kindex detach
1894@item detach
1895When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1896@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1897the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1898that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1899are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1900@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1901executing the command.
1902@end table
1903
1904If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1905attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1906for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1907control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1908confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1909messages}).
1910
6d2ebf8b 1911@node Kill Process
c906108c 1912@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1913
1914@table @code
1915@kindex kill
1916@item kill
1917Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1918@end table
1919
1920This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1921running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1922is running.
1923
1924On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1925while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1926@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1927outside the debugger.
1928
1929The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1930relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1931executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1932next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1933reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1934breakpoint settings).
1935
6d2ebf8b 1936@node Threads
c906108c 1937@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1938
1939@cindex threads of execution
1940@cindex multiple threads
1941@cindex switching threads
1942In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1943may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1944of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1945the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1946that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1947modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1948registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1949
1950@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1951programs:
1952
1953@itemize @bullet
1954@item automatic notification of new threads
1955@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1956@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 1957@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
1958a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1959@item thread-specific breakpoints
1960@end itemize
1961
c906108c
SS
1962@quotation
1963@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1964@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1965If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1966effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1967from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1968like this:
1969
1970@smallexample
1971(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1972(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1973Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1974see the IDs of currently known threads.
1975@end smallexample
1976@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1977@c doesn't support threads"?
1978@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1979
1980@cindex focus of debugging
1981@cindex current thread
1982The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1983threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1984control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1985This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1986program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1987
41afff9a 1988@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
1989@cindex thread identifier (system)
1990@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1991@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1992@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1993Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1994the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1995form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1996whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1997LynxOS, you might see
1998
1999@example
2000[New process 35 thread 27]
2001@end example
2002
2003@noindent
2004when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2005the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2006further qualifier.
2007
2008@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2009@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2010@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2011@c program?
2012@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2013@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2014@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2015
2016@cindex thread number
2017@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2018For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2019number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2020
2021@table @code
2022@kindex info threads
2023@item info threads
2024Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2025program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2026
2027@enumerate
2028@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2029
2030@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2031
2032@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2033@end enumerate
2034
2035@noindent
2036An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2037indicates the current thread.
2038
5d161b24 2039For example,
c906108c
SS
2040@end table
2041@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2042
2043@smallexample
2044(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2045 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2046 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2047* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2048 at threadtest.c:68
2049@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2050
2051On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2052
2053@cindex thread number
2054@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2055For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2056number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2057thread in your program.
2058
41afff9a
EZ
2059@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2060@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2061@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2062@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2063@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2064Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2065both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2066form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2067whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2068HP-UX, you see
2069
2070@example
2071[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2072@end example
2073
2074@noindent
5d161b24 2075when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2076
2077@table @code
2078@kindex info threads
2079@item info threads
2080Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2081program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2082
2083@enumerate
2084@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2085
2086@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2087
2088@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2089@end enumerate
2090
2091@noindent
2092An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2093indicates the current thread.
2094
5d161b24 2095For example,
c906108c
SS
2096@end table
2097@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2098
2099@example
2100(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2101 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2102 at quicksort.c:137
2103 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2104 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2105 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2106 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2107@end example
c906108c
SS
2108
2109@table @code
2110@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2111@item thread @var{threadno}
2112Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2113argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2114shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2115@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2116you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2117
2118@smallexample
2119@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2120(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2121[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21220x34e5 in sigpause ()
2123@end smallexample
2124
2125@noindent
2126As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2127@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2128threads.
c906108c
SS
2129
2130@kindex thread apply
2131@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2132The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2133more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2134with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2135@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2136threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2137@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2138@end table
2139
2140@cindex automatic thread selection
2141@cindex switching threads automatically
2142@cindex threads, automatic switching
2143Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2144signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2145signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2146message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2147thread.
2148
2149@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2150more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2151programs with multiple threads.
2152
2153@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2154watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2155
6d2ebf8b 2156@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2157@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2158
2159@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2160@cindex multiple processes
2161@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2162On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2163programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2164function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2165parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2166set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2167will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2168will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2169
2170However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2171which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2172the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2173only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2174so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2175on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2176get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2177@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2178the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2179the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2180
53a5351d
JM
2181On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2182debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2183@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2184
2185By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2186the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2187
2188If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2189use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2190
2191@table @code
2192@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2193@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2194Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2195@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2196process. The @var{mode} can be:
2197
2198@table @code
2199@item parent
2200The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2201unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2202
2203@item child
2204The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2205unimpeded.
2206
2207@item ask
2208The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2209@end table
2210
2211@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2212Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2213@end table
2214
2215If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2216@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2217breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2218@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2219the child process's @code{main}.
2220
2221When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2222child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2223
2224If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2225call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2226use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2227argument.
2228
2229You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2230a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2231Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2232
6d2ebf8b 2233@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2234@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2235
2236The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2237program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2238trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2239
7a292a7a
SS
2240Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2241such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2242@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2243change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2244continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2245ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2246explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2247
2248@table @code
2249@kindex info program
2250@item info program
2251Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2252running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2253@end table
2254
2255@menu
2256* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2257* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2258* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2259* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2260@end menu
2261
6d2ebf8b 2262@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2263@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2264
2265@cindex breakpoints
2266A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2267the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2268control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2269breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2270Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2271should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2272program.
2273
2274In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2275breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2276a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2277is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2278not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2279arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2280
2281@cindex watchpoints
2282@cindex memory tracing
2283@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2284@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2285A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2286when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2287command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2288watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2289any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2290and watchpoints using the same commands.
2291
2292You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2293whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2294Automatic display}.
2295
2296@cindex catchpoints
2297@cindex breakpoint on events
2298A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2299when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2300exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2301different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2302catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2303other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2304@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2305
2306@cindex breakpoint numbers
2307@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2308@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2309catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2310starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2311features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2312breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2313@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2314enable it again.
2315
c5394b80
JM
2316@cindex breakpoint ranges
2317@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2318Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2319operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2320@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2321hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2322all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2323
c906108c
SS
2324@menu
2325* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2326* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2327* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2328* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2329* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2330* Conditions:: Break conditions
2331* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2332* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2333* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2334@end menu
2335
6d2ebf8b 2336@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2337@subsection Setting breakpoints
2338
5d161b24 2339@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2340@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2341@c
2342@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2343
2344@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2345@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2346@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2347@cindex latest breakpoint
2348Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2349@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2350number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2351Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2352convenience variables.
2353
2354You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2355
2356@table @code
2357@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2358Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2359When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2360C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2361@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2362
2363@item break +@var{offset}
2364@itemx break -@var{offset}
2365Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2366at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2367(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2368
2369@item break @var{linenum}
2370Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2371The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2372The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2373code on that line.
2374
2375@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2376Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2377
2378@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2379Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2380@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2381superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2382functions.
2383
2384@item break *@var{address}
2385Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2386breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2387information or source files.
2388
2389@item break
2390When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2391the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2392(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2393innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2394returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2395@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2396that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2397@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2398the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2399inside loops.
2400
2401@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2402least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2403would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2404breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2405existed when your program stopped.
2406
2407@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2408Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2409@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2410value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2411@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2412above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2413,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2414
2415@kindex tbreak
2416@item tbreak @var{args}
2417Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2418same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2419way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2420program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2421
c906108c
SS
2422@kindex hbreak
2423@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2424Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2425@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2426breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2427have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2428debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2429changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2430provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2431will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2432address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2433breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2434example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2435@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2436or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2437(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2438
2439@kindex thbreak
2440@item thbreak @var{args}
2441Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2442are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2443the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2444the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2445first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2446command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2447may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2448See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2449
2450@kindex rbreak
2451@cindex regular expression
2452@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2453Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2454@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2455matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2456breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2457the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2458them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2459
2460The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2461like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2462shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2463an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2464@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2465match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2466
b37052ae 2467When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2468breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2469classes.
c906108c
SS
2470
2471@kindex info breakpoints
2472@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2473@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2474@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2475@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2476Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2477not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2478
2479@table @emph
2480@item Breakpoint Numbers
2481@item Type
2482Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2483@item Disposition
2484Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2485@item Enabled or Disabled
2486Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2487that are not enabled.
2488@item Address
2df3850c 2489Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2490@item What
2491Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2492line number.
2493@end table
2494
2495@noindent
2496If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2497the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2498are listed after that.
2499
2500@noindent
2501@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2502number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2503convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2504the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2505listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2506
2507@noindent
2508@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2509has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2510@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2511hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2512was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2513will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2514@end table
2515
2516@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2517your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2518the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2519(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2520
2521@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2522@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2523@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2524purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2525These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2526@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2527
2528You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2529@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2530
2531@table @code
2532@kindex maint info breakpoints
2533@item maint info breakpoints
2534Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2535breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2536internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2537breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2538is shown:
2539
2540@table @code
2541@item breakpoint
2542Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2543
2544@item watchpoint
2545Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2546
2547@item longjmp
2548Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2549@code{longjmp} calls.
2550
2551@item longjmp resume
2552Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2553
2554@item until
2555Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2556
2557@item finish
2558Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2559
c906108c
SS
2560@item shlib events
2561Shared library events.
53a5351d 2562
c906108c 2563@end table
53a5351d 2564
c906108c
SS
2565@end table
2566
2567
6d2ebf8b 2568@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2569@subsection Setting watchpoints
2570
2571@cindex setting watchpoints
2572@cindex software watchpoints
2573@cindex hardware watchpoints
2574You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2575expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2576this may happen.
2577
2578Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2579hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2580program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2581times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2582catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2583culprit.)
2584
d4f3574e 2585On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2586@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2587hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2588program.
2589
2590@table @code
2591@kindex watch
2592@item watch @var{expr}
2593Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2594is written into by the program and its value changes.
2595
2596@kindex rwatch
2597@item rwatch @var{expr}
2598Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2599
2600@kindex awatch
2601@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2602Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2603by the program.
c906108c
SS
2604
2605@kindex info watchpoints
2606@item info watchpoints
2607This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2608it is the same as @code{info break}.
2609@end table
2610
2611@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2612watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2613value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2614cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2615executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2616statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2617
2618When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2619
2620@example
2621Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2622@end example
2623
2624@noindent
2625if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2626
7be570e7
JM
2627Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2628hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2629value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2630every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2631that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2632hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2633will print a message like this:
2634
2635@smallexample
2636Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2637@end smallexample
2638
2639Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2640data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2641watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2642can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2643cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2644double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2645wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2646into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2647
2648If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2649to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2650Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2651time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2652able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2653warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2654
2655@smallexample
2656Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2657@end smallexample
2658
2659@noindent
2660If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2661
2662The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2663or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2664data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2665hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2666both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2667watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2668@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2669watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2670@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2671Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2672
2673If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2674any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2675kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2676
7be570e7
JM
2677@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2678(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2679they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2680which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2681being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2682and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2683rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2684way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2685@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2686
c906108c
SS
2687@quotation
2688@cindex watchpoints and threads
2689@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2690@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2691usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2692can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2693you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2694thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2695can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2696@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2697the expression.
53a5351d 2698
d4f3574e 2699@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2700@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2701have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2702watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2703single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2704change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2705confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2706software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2707when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2708watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2709@end quotation
c906108c 2710
6d2ebf8b 2711@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2712@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2713@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2714@cindex exception handlers
2715@cindex event handling
2716
2717You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2718kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2719shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2720
2721@table @code
2722@kindex catch
2723@item catch @var{event}
2724Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2725@table @code
2726@item throw
2727@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2728The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2729
2730@item catch
2731@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2732The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2733
2734@item exec
2735@kindex catch exec
2736A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2737
2738@item fork
2739@kindex catch fork
2740A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2741
2742@item vfork
2743@kindex catch vfork
2744A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2745
2746@item load
2747@itemx load @var{libname}
2748@kindex catch load
2749The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2750@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2751
2752@item unload
2753@itemx unload @var{libname}
2754@kindex catch unload
2755The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2756of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2757@end table
2758
2759@item tcatch @var{event}
2760Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2761automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2762
2763@end table
2764
2765Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2766
b37052ae 2767There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2768(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2769
2770@itemize @bullet
2771@item
2772If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2773control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2774raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2775returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2776simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2777that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2778you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2779disabled within interactive calls.
2780
2781@item
2782You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2783
2784@item
2785You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2786@end itemize
2787
2788@cindex raise exceptions
2789Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2790if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2791stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2792can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2793breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2794out where the exception was raised.
2795
2796To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2797knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2798raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2799which has the following ANSI C interface:
2800
2801@example
2802 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2803 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2804 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2805@end example
2806
2807@noindent
2808To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2809unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2810(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2811
2812With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2813that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2814a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2815breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2816raised.
2817
2818
6d2ebf8b 2819@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2820@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2821
2822@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2823@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2824It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2825catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2826to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2827breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2828
2829With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2830where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2831delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2832their breakpoint numbers.
2833
2834It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2835automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2836when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2837
2838@table @code
2839@kindex clear
2840@item clear
2841Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2842selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2843the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2844breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2845
2846@item clear @var{function}
2847@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2848Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2849
2850@item clear @var{linenum}
2851@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2852Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2853
2854@cindex delete breakpoints
2855@kindex delete
41afff9a 2856@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2857@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2858Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2859ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2860breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2861confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2862@end table
2863
6d2ebf8b 2864@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2865@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2866
2867@kindex disable breakpoints
2868@kindex enable breakpoints
2869Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2870prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2871it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2872that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2873
2874You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2875the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2876or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2877@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2878catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2879
2880A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2881states of enablement:
2882
2883@itemize @bullet
2884@item
2885Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2886with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2887@item
2888Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2889@item
2890Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2891disabled.
c906108c
SS
2892@item
2893Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2894immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2895set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2896@end itemize
2897
2898You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2899watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2900
2901@table @code
2902@kindex disable breakpoints
2903@kindex disable
41afff9a 2904@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2905@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2906Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2907listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2908options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2909case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2910@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2911
2912@kindex enable breakpoints
2913@kindex enable
c5394b80 2914@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2915Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2916become effective once again in stopping your program.
2917
c5394b80 2918@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2919Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2920of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2921
c5394b80 2922@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2923Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2924deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2925@end table
2926
d4f3574e
SS
2927@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2928@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2929Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2930,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2931subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2932the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2933breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2934breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2935stepping}.)
2936
6d2ebf8b 2937@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2938@subsection Break conditions
2939@cindex conditional breakpoints
2940@cindex breakpoint conditions
2941
2942@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2943@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2944The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2945specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2946breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2947programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2948a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2949and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2950
2951This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2952situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2953when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2954by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2955@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2956
2957Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2958since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2959it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2960and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2961one.
2962
2963Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2964your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2965that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2966format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2967unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2968that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2969program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2970breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2971conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2972purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2973(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2974
2975Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2976@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2977Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2978with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2979
c906108c
SS
2980You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2981The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2982@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2983catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2984
2985@table @code
2986@kindex condition
2987@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2988Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2989watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2990breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2991@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2992@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2993syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2994referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2995symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2996prints an error message:
2997
2998@example
2999No symbol "foo" in current context.
3000@end example
3001
3002@noindent
c906108c
SS
3003@value{GDBN} does
3004not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3005command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3006@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3007
3008@item condition @var{bnum}
3009Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3010an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3011@end table
3012
3013@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3014A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3015breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3016useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3017count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3018is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3019therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3020ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3021the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3022value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3023your program reaches it.
3024
3025@table @code
3026@kindex ignore
3027@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3028Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3029The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3030execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3031takes no action.
3032
3033To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3034a count of zero.
3035
3036When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3037breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3038@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3039Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3040
3041If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3042condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3043@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3044
3045You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3046as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3047is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3048variables}.
3049@end table
3050
3051Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3052
3053
6d2ebf8b 3054@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3055@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3056
3057@cindex breakpoint commands
3058You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3059commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3060example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3061enable other breakpoints.
3062
3063@table @code
3064@kindex commands
3065@kindex end
3066@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3067@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3068@itemx end
3069Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3070themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3071@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3072
3073To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3074follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3075
3076With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3077breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3078recently encountered).
3079@end table
3080
3081Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3082disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3083
3084You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3085use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3086that resumes execution.
3087
3088Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3089execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3090(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3091another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3092ambiguities about which list to execute.
3093
3094@kindex silent
3095If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3096usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3097be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3098then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3099see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3100meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3101
3102The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3103print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3104breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3105
3106For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3107value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3108
3109@example
3110break foo if x>0
3111commands
3112silent
3113printf "x is %d\n",x
3114cont
3115end
3116@end example
3117
3118One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3119you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3120of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3121erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3122to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3123so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3124command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3125
3126@example
3127break 403
3128commands
3129silent
3130set x = y + 4
3131cont
3132end
3133@end example
3134
6d2ebf8b 3135@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3136@subsection Breakpoint menus
3137@cindex overloading
3138@cindex symbol overloading
3139
b37052ae 3140Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3141to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3142This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3143@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3144a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3145something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3146particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3147you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3148waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3149options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3150sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3151@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3152breakpoints.
3153
3154For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3155breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3156We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3157
3158@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3159@smallexample
3160@group
3161(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3162[0] cancel
3163[1] all
3164[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3165[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3166[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3167[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3168[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3169[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3170> 2 4 6
3171Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3172Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3173Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3174Multiple breakpoints were set.
3175Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3176 breakpoints.
3177(@value{GDBP})
3178@end group
3179@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3180
3181@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3182@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3183@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3184@c
3185@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3186@c
d4f3574e
SS
3187Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3188any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3189attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3190@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3191
3192@example
3193Cannot insert breakpoints.
3194The same program may be running in another process.
3195@end example
3196
3197When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3198
3199@enumerate
3200@item
3201Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3202
3203@item
5d161b24 3204Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3205name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3206that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3207Then start your program again.
3208
3209@item
3210Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3211linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3212to nonsharable executables.
3213@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3214@c @end ifclear
3215
d4f3574e
SS
3216A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3217hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3218
3219@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3220@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3221@smallexample
3222Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3223You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3224@end smallexample
3225
3226@noindent
3227This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3228only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3229watchpoints it needs to insert.
3230
3231When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3232hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3233
3234
6d2ebf8b 3235@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3236@section Continuing and stepping
3237
3238@cindex stepping
3239@cindex continuing
3240@cindex resuming execution
3241@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3242completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3243one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3244line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3245particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3246your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3247it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3248@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3249
3250@table @code
3251@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3252@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3253@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3254@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3255@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3256@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3257Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3258any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3259@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3260ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3261@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3262
3263The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3264stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3265@code{continue} is ignored.
3266
d4f3574e
SS
3267The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3268debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3269purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3270@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3271@end table
3272
3273To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3274(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3275calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3276different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3277
3278A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3279(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3280beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3281is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3282and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3283interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3284
3285@table @code
3286@kindex step
41afff9a 3287@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3288@item step
3289Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3290line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3291abbreviated @code{s}.
3292
3293@quotation
3294@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3295@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3296@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3297@c distinction here.
3298@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3299within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3300execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3301debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3302is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3303without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3304below.
3305@end quotation
3306
4a92d011
EZ
3307The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3308line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3309@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3310to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3311the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3312called within the line.
c906108c 3313
d4f3574e
SS
3314Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3315number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3316@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3317on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3318was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3319
3320@item step @var{count}
3321Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3322breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3323@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3324
3325@kindex next
41afff9a 3326@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3327@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3328Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3329This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3330the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3331control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3332that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3333is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3334
3335An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3336
3337
3338@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3339@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3340@c
3341@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3342@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3343@c function are executed without stopping.
3344
d4f3574e
SS
3345The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3346source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3347@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3348
b90a5f51
CF
3349@kindex set step-mode
3350@item set step-mode
3351@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3352@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3353@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3354The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3355stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3356information rather than stepping over it.
3357
4a92d011
EZ
3358This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3359machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3360want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3361
3362@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3363Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3364debug information. This is the default.
3365
c906108c
SS
3366@kindex finish
3367@item finish
3368Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3369returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3370
3371Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3372,Returning from a function}).
3373
3374@kindex until
41afff9a 3375@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3376@item until
3377@itemx u
3378Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3379current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3380stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3381command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3382automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3383than the address of the jump.
3384
3385This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3386though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3387exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3388simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3389through the next iteration.
3390
3391@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3392stack frame.
3393
3394@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3395of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3396example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3397(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3398@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3399
3400@example
3401(@value{GDBP}) f
3402#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3403206 expand_input();
3404(@value{GDBP}) until
3405195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3406@end example
3407
3408This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3409generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3410start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3411written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3412to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3413expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3414statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3415
3416@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3417instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3418argument.
3419
3420@item until @var{location}
3421@itemx u @var{location}
3422Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3423reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3424the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3425,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3426and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3427
3428@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3429@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3430@item stepi
96a2c332 3431@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3432@itemx si
3433Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3434
3435It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3436instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3437instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3438Display,, Automatic display}.
3439
3440An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3441
3442@need 750
3443@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3444@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3445@item nexti
96a2c332 3446@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3447@itemx ni
3448Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3449proceed until the function returns.
3450
3451An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3452@end table
3453
6d2ebf8b 3454@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3455@section Signals
3456@cindex signals
3457
3458A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3459operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3460kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3461signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3462@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3463memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3464the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3465requested an alarm).
3466
3467@cindex fatal signals
3468Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3469functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3470errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3471program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3472@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3473fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3474
3475@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3476program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3477signal.
3478
3479@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3480Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3481@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3482(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3483but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3484You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3485
3486@table @code
3487@kindex info signals
3488@item info signals
96a2c332 3489@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3490Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3491handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3492the defined types of signals.
3493
d4f3574e 3494@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3495
3496@kindex handle
3497@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3498Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3499can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3500@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3501@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3502known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3503@end table
3504
3505@c @group
3506The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3507Their full names are:
3508
3509@table @code
3510@item nostop
3511@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3512still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3513
3514@item stop
3515@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3516the @code{print} keyword as well.
3517
3518@item print
3519@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3520
3521@item noprint
3522@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3523implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3524
3525@item pass
5ece1a18 3526@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3527@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3528can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3529and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3530
3531@item nopass
5ece1a18 3532@itemx ignore
c906108c 3533@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3534@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3535@end table
3536@c @end group
3537
d4f3574e
SS
3538When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3539program until you
c906108c
SS
3540continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3541effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3542after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3543command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3544program sees that signal when you continue.
3545
24f93129
EZ
3546The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3547non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3548@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3549erroneous signals.
3550
c906108c
SS
3551You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3552seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3553or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3554due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3555values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3556execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3557a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3558you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3559program a signal}.
c906108c 3560
6d2ebf8b 3561@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3562@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3563
3564When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3565programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3566breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3567
3568@table @code
3569@cindex breakpoints and threads
3570@cindex thread breakpoints
3571@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3572@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3573@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3574@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3575writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3576
3577Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3578to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3579particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3580numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3581column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3582
3583If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3584breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3585program.
3586
3587You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3588well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3589breakpoint condition, like this:
3590
3591@smallexample
2df3850c 3592(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3593@end smallexample
3594
3595@end table
3596
3597@cindex stopped threads
3598@cindex threads, stopped
3599Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3600@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3601allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3602switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3603underfoot.
3604
3605@cindex continuing threads
3606@cindex threads, continuing
3607Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3608executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3609like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3610
3611In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3612Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3613system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3614execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3615single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3616statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3617stops.
3618
3619You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3620continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3621thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3622first thread completes whatever you requested.
3623
3624On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3625thread to run.
3626
3627@table @code
3628@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3629Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3630locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3631current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3632mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3633``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3634stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3635when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3636function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3637like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3638thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3639@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3640
3641@item show scheduler-locking
3642Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3643@end table
3644
c906108c 3645
6d2ebf8b 3646@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3647@chapter Examining the Stack
3648
3649When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3650stopped and how it got there.
3651
3652@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3653Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3654is generated.
3655That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3656the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3657and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3658The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3659The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3660stack}.
3661
3662When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3663stack allow you to see all of this information.
3664
3665@cindex selected frame
3666One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3667@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3668particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3669your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3670special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3671interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3672
3673When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3674currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3675@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3676
3677@menu
3678* Frames:: Stack frames
3679* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3680* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3681* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3682
3683@end menu
3684
6d2ebf8b 3685@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3686@section Stack frames
3687
d4f3574e 3688@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3689@cindex stack frame
3690The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3691frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3692with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3693to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3694which the function is executing.
3695
3696@cindex initial frame
3697@cindex outermost frame
3698@cindex innermost frame
3699When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3700function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3701@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3702made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3703is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3704the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3705actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3706recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3707
3708@cindex frame pointer
3709Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3710stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3711kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3712address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3713in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3714going on in that frame.
3715
3716@cindex frame number
3717@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3718zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3719and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3720they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3721frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3722
6d2ebf8b
SS
3723@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3724@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3725@cindex frameless execution
3726Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3727without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3728@example
3729@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3730@end example
3731generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3732This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3733the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3734with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3735has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3736it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3737correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3738no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3739
3740@table @code
d4f3574e 3741@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3742@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3743@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3744The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3745and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3746address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3747@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3748
3749@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3750@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3751@item select-frame
3752The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3753to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3754@code{frame}.
3755@end table
3756
6d2ebf8b 3757@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3758@section Backtraces
3759
3760@cindex backtraces
3761@cindex tracebacks
3762@cindex stack traces
3763A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3764line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3765frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3766stack.
3767
3768@table @code
3769@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3770@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3771@item backtrace
3772@itemx bt
3773Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3774frames in the stack.
3775
3776You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3777character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3778
3779@item backtrace @var{n}
3780@itemx bt @var{n}
3781Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3782
3783@item backtrace -@var{n}
3784@itemx bt -@var{n}
3785Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3786@end table
3787
3788@kindex where
3789@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3790@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3791The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3792are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3793
3794Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3795The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3796print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3797line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3798counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3799line number.
3800
3801Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3802@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3803
3804@smallexample
3805@group
5d161b24 3806#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3807 at builtin.c:993
3808#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3809#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3810 at macro.c:71
3811(More stack frames follow...)
3812@end group
3813@end smallexample
3814
3815@noindent
3816The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3817value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3818code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3819
6d2ebf8b 3820@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3821@section Selecting a frame
3822
3823Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3824whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3825selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3826of the stack frame just selected.
3827
3828@table @code
d4f3574e 3829@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3830@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3831@item frame @var{n}
3832@itemx f @var{n}
3833Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3834(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3835innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3836@code{main}.
3837
3838@item frame @var{addr}
3839@itemx f @var{addr}
3840Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3841chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3842impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3843addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3844switches between them.
3845
c906108c
SS
3846On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3847select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3848
3849On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3850pointer and a program counter.
3851
3852On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3853pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3854@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3855@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3856@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3857
3858@kindex up
3859@item up @var{n}
3860Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3861advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3862that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3863
3864@kindex down
41afff9a 3865@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3866@item down @var{n}
3867Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3868advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3869that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3870abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3871@end table
3872
3873All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3874frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3875arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3876frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3877
3878@need 1000
3879For example:
3880
3881@smallexample
3882@group
3883(@value{GDBP}) up
3884#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3885 at env.c:10
388610 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3887@end group
3888@end smallexample
3889
3890After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3891prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3892@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3893
3894@table @code
3895@kindex down-silently
3896@kindex up-silently
3897@item up-silently @var{n}
3898@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3899These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3900respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3901causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3902in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3903distracting.
3904@end table
3905
6d2ebf8b 3906@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3907@section Information about a frame
3908
3909There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3910stack frame.
3911
3912@table @code
3913@item frame
3914@itemx f
3915When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3916frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3917selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3918argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3919@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3920
3921@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3922@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3923@item info frame
3924@itemx info f
3925This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3926including:
3927
3928@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3929@item
3930the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3931@item
3932the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3933@item
3934the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3935@item
3936the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3937@item
3938the address of the frame's arguments
3939@item
d4f3574e
SS
3940the address of the frame's local variables
3941@item
c906108c
SS
3942the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3943@item
3944which registers were saved in the frame
3945@end itemize
3946
3947@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3948something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3949the usual conventions.
3950
3951@item info frame @var{addr}
3952@itemx info f @var{addr}
3953Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3954selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3955command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3956architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3957@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3958
3959@kindex info args
3960@item info args
3961Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3962
3963@item info locals
3964@kindex info locals
3965Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3966line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3967accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3968
c906108c 3969@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3970@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3971@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3972@item info catch
3973Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3974current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3975exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3976@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3977@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3978
c906108c
SS
3979@end table
3980
c906108c 3981
6d2ebf8b 3982@node Source
c906108c
SS
3983@chapter Examining Source Files
3984
3985@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3986information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3987used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3988the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3989(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3990execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3991source files by explicit command.
3992
7a292a7a 3993If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3994prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3995@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3996
3997@menu
3998* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3999* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4000* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4001* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4002@end menu
4003
6d2ebf8b 4004@node List
c906108c
SS
4005@section Printing source lines
4006
4007@kindex list
41afff9a 4008@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4009To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4010(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4011There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4012
4013Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4014
4015@table @code
4016@item list @var{linenum}
4017Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4018current source file.
4019
4020@item list @var{function}
4021Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4022@var{function}.
4023
4024@item list
4025Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4026@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4027printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4028as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4029Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4030
4031@item list -
4032Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4033@end table
4034
4035By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4036the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4037
4038@table @code
4039@kindex set listsize
4040@item set listsize @var{count}
4041Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4042the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4043
4044@kindex show listsize
4045@item show listsize
4046Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4047@end table
4048
4049Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4050so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4051than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4052argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4053each repetition moves up in the source file.
4054
4055@cindex linespec
4056In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4057@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4058of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4059Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4060
4061@table @code
4062@item list @var{linespec}
4063Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4064
4065@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4066Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4067linespecs.
4068
4069@item list ,@var{last}
4070Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4071
4072@item list @var{first},
4073Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4074
4075@item list +
4076Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4077
4078@item list -
4079Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4080
4081@item list
4082As described in the preceding table.
4083@end table
4084
4085Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4086kinds of linespec.
4087
4088@table @code
4089@item @var{number}
4090Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4091When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4092the same source file as the first linespec.
4093
4094@item +@var{offset}
4095Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4096When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4097two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4098first linespec.
4099
4100@item -@var{offset}
4101Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4102
4103@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4104Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4105
4106@item @var{function}
4107Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4108For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4109
4110@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4111Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4112function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4113file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4114identically named functions in different source files.
4115
4116@item *@var{address}
4117Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4118@var{address} may be any expression.
4119@end table
4120
6d2ebf8b 4121@node Search
c906108c
SS
4122@section Searching source files
4123@cindex searching
4124@kindex reverse-search
4125
4126There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4127regular expression.
4128
4129@table @code
4130@kindex search
4131@kindex forward-search
4132@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4133@itemx search @var{regexp}
4134The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4135starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4136@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4137synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4138@code{fo}.
4139
4140@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4141The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4142with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4143for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4144this command as @code{rev}.
4145@end table
c906108c 4146
6d2ebf8b 4147@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4148@section Specifying source directories
4149
4150@cindex source path
4151@cindex directories for source files
4152Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4153files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4154the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4155session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4156this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4157it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4158in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4159the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4160the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4161path.
4162
4163If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4164object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4165too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4166compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4167last resort.
4168
4169Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4170any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4171each line is in the file.
4172
4173@kindex directory
4174@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4175When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4176and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4177To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4178
4179@table @code
4180@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4181@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4182Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4183directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4184(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4185part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4186whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4187path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4188
4189@kindex cdir
4190@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4191@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4192@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4193@cindex compilation directory
4194@cindex current directory
4195@cindex working directory
4196@cindex directory, current
4197@cindex directory, compilation
4198You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4199directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4200working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4201tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4202session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4203directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4204
4205@item directory
4206Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4207
4208@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4209@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4210
4211@item show directories
4212@kindex show directories
4213Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4214@end table
4215
4216If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4217interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4218versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4219
4220@enumerate
4221@item
4222Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4223
4224@item
4225Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4226directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4227directories in one command.
4228@end enumerate
4229
6d2ebf8b 4230@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4231@section Source and machine code
4232
4233You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4234addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4235a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4236mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4237line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4238well as hex.
4239
4240@table @code
4241@kindex info line
4242@item info line @var{linespec}
4243Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4244source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4245the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4246source lines}).
4247@end table
4248
4249For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4250the object code for the first line of function
4251@code{m4_changequote}:
4252
d4f3574e
SS
4253@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4254@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4255@smallexample
96a2c332 4256(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4257Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4258@end smallexample
4259
4260@noindent
4261We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4262@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4263@smallexample
4264(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4265Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4266@end smallexample
4267
4268@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4269@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4270After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4271is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4272sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4273,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4274convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4275variables}).
4276
4277@table @code
4278@kindex disassemble
4279@cindex assembly instructions
4280@cindex instructions, assembly
4281@cindex machine instructions
4282@cindex listing machine instructions
4283@item disassemble
4284This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4285instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4286program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4287command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4288surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4289(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4290@end table
4291
c906108c
SS
4292The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4293HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4294
4295@smallexample
4296(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4297Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
42980x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
42990x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
43000x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
43010x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
43020x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
43030x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
43040x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
43050x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4306End of assembler dump.
4307@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4308
4309Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4310mnemonics or other syntax.
4311
4312@table @code
d4f3574e 4313@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4314@cindex assembly instructions
4315@cindex instructions, assembly
4316@cindex machine instructions
4317@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4318@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4319@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4320@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4321Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4322program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4323
4324Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4325can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4326The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4327assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4328@end table
4329
4330
6d2ebf8b 4331@node Data
c906108c
SS
4332@chapter Examining Data
4333
4334@cindex printing data
4335@cindex examining data
4336@kindex print
4337@kindex inspect
4338@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4339@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4340@c different window or something like that.
4341The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4342command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4343evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4344program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4345Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4346
4347@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4348@item print @var{expr}
4349@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4350@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4351value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4352you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4353@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4354formats}.
4355
4356@item print
4357@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4358If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4359@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4360conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4361@end table
4362
4363A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4364It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4365specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4366
7a292a7a 4367If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4368fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4369command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4370Table}.
c906108c
SS
4371
4372@menu
4373* Expressions:: Expressions
4374* Variables:: Program variables
4375* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4376* Output Formats:: Output formats
4377* Memory:: Examining memory
4378* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4379* Print Settings:: Print settings
4380* Value History:: Value history
4381* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4382* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4383* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4384* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
c906108c
SS
4385@end menu
4386
6d2ebf8b 4387@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4388@section Expressions
4389
4390@cindex expressions
4391@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4392compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4393by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4394@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4395and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4396by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4397
d4f3574e
SS
4398@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4399the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4400you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4401memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4402
c906108c
SS
4403Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4404this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4405Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4406languages.
4407
4408In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4409expressions regardless of your programming language.
4410
4411Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4412useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4413at that address in memory.
4414@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4415
4416@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4417to programming languages:
4418
4419@table @code
4420@item @@
4421@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4422@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4423
4424@item ::
4425@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4426function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4427
4428@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4429@cindex type casting memory
4430@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4431@cindex casts, to view memory
4432@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4433Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4434memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4435pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4436a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4437normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4438@end table
4439
6d2ebf8b 4440@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4441@section Program variables
4442
4443The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4444in your program.
4445
4446Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4447(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4448
4449@itemize @bullet
4450@item
4451global (or file-static)
4452@end itemize
4453
5d161b24 4454@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4455
4456@itemize @bullet
4457@item
4458visible according to the scope rules of the
4459programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4460@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4461
4462@noindent This means that in the function
4463
4464@example
4465foo (a)
4466 int a;
4467@{
4468 bar (a);
4469 @{
4470 int b = test ();
4471 bar (b);
4472 @}
4473@}
4474@end example
4475
4476@noindent
4477you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4478executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4479examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4480the block where @code{b} is declared.
4481
4482@cindex variable name conflict
4483There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4484scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4485in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4486function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4487happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4488you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4489using the colon-colon notation:
4490
d4f3574e 4491@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4492@iftex
4493@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4494@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4495@end iftex
4496@example
4497@var{file}::@var{variable}
4498@var{function}::@var{variable}
4499@end example
4500
4501@noindent
4502Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4503static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4504make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4505to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4506
4507@example
4508(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4509@end example
4510
b37052ae 4511@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4512This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4513use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4514scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4515@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4516@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4517
4518@cindex wrong values
4519@cindex variable values, wrong
4520@quotation
4521@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4522wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4523scope, and just before exit.
4524@end quotation
4525You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4526This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4527set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4528stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4529values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4530also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4531after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4532variable definitions may be gone.
4533
4534This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4535To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4536when compiling.
4537
d4f3574e
SS
4538@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4539Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4540unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4541opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4542offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4543might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4544happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4545
4546@example
4547No symbol "foo" in current context.
4548@end example
4549
4550To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4551different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4552formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4553supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4554in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4555to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4556debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4557Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4558information.
4559
4560
6d2ebf8b 4561@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4562@section Artificial arrays
4563
4564@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4565@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4566It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4567same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4568dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4569program.
4570
4571You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4572@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4573operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4574and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4575of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4576the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4577argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4578following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4579example. If a program says
4580
4581@example
4582int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4583@end example
4584
4585@noindent
4586you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4587
4588@example
4589p *array@@len
4590@end example
4591
4592The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4593with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4594subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4595Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4596(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4597
4598Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4599This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4600The value need not be in memory:
4601@example
4602(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4603$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4604@end example
4605
4606As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4607@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4608the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4609@example
4610(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4611$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4612@end example
4613
4614Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4615moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4616actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4617of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4618to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4619variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4620interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4621instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4622structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4623in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4624
4625@example
4626set $i = 0
4627p dtab[$i++]->fv
4628@key{RET}
4629@key{RET}
4630@dots{}
4631@end example
4632
6d2ebf8b 4633@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4634@section Output formats
4635
4636@cindex formatted output
4637@cindex output formats
4638By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4639this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4640in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4641at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4642these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4643
4644The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4645already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4646@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4647letters supported are:
4648
4649@table @code
4650@item x
4651Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4652hexadecimal.
4653
4654@item d
4655Print as integer in signed decimal.
4656
4657@item u
4658Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4659
4660@item o
4661Print as integer in octal.
4662
4663@item t
4664Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4665@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4666used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4667see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4668
4669@item a
4670@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4671@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4672Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4673the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4674where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4675
4676@example
4677(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4678$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4679@end example
4680
3d67e040
EZ
4681@noindent
4682The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4683@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4684
c906108c
SS
4685@item c
4686Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4687
4688@item f
4689Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4690using typical floating point syntax.
4691@end table
4692
4693For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4694
4695@example
4696p/x $pc
4697@end example
4698
4699@noindent
4700Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4701names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4702
4703To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4704you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4705expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4706
6d2ebf8b 4707@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4708@section Examining memory
4709
4710You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4711any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4712
4713@cindex examining memory
4714@table @code
41afff9a 4715@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4716@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4717@itemx x @var{addr}
4718@itemx x
4719Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4720@end table
4721
4722@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4723much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4724expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4725If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4726Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4727
4728@table @r
4729@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4730The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4731how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4732@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4733@c 4.1.2.
4734
4735@item @var{f}, the display format
4736The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4737@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4738The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4739The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4740
4741@item @var{u}, the unit size
4742The unit size is any of
4743
4744@table @code
4745@item b
4746Bytes.
4747@item h
4748Halfwords (two bytes).
4749@item w
4750Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4751@item g
4752Giant words (eight bytes).
4753@end table
4754
4755Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4756default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4757@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4758
4759@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4760@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4761memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4762it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4763@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4764@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4765other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4766the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4767starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4768a value from memory).
4769@end table
4770
4771For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4772(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4773starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4774words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4775@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4776
4777Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4778letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4779unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4780specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4781(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4782
4783Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4784and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4785@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4786including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4787alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4788Code,,Source and machine code}.
4789
4790All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4791easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4792you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4793instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4794with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4795the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4796for successive uses of @code{x}.
4797
4798@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4799The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4800in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4801would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4802subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4803@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4804examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4805@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4806the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4807
4808If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4809are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4810address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4811
6d2ebf8b 4812@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4813@section Automatic display
4814@cindex automatic display
4815@cindex display of expressions
4816
4817If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4818(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4819display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4820Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4821to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4822The automatic display looks like this:
4823
4824@example
48252: foo = 38
48263: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4827@end example
4828
4829@noindent
4830This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4831displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4832specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4833whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4834format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4835or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4836supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4837
4838@table @code
4839@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4840@item display @var{expr}
4841Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4842each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4843
4844@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4845
d4f3574e 4846@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4847For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4848count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4849arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4850@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4851
4852@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4853For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4854number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4855be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4856doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4857@end table
4858
4859For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4860instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4861is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4862
4863@table @code
4864@kindex delete display
4865@kindex undisplay
4866@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4867@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4868Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4869
4870@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4871(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4872
4873@kindex disable display
4874@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4875Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4876item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4877enabled again later.
4878
4879@kindex enable display
4880@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4881Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4882again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4883
4884@item display
4885Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4886done when your program stops.
4887
4888@kindex info display
4889@item info display
4890Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4891automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4892values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4893It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4894because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4895@end table
4896
4897If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4898sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4899expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4900variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4901@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4902@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4903continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4904there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4905automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4906is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4907
6d2ebf8b 4908@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4909@section Print settings
4910
4911@cindex format options
4912@cindex print settings
4913@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4914and symbols are printed.
4915
4916@noindent
4917These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4918
4919@table @code
4920@kindex set print address
4921@item set print address
4922@itemx set print address on
4923@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4924traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4925even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4926is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4927@code{set print address on}:
4928
4929@smallexample
4930@group
4931(@value{GDBP}) f
4932#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4933 at input.c:530
4934530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4935@end group
4936@end smallexample
4937
4938@item set print address off
4939Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4940this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4941
4942@smallexample
4943@group
4944(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4945(@value{GDBP}) f
4946#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4947530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4948@end group
4949@end smallexample
4950
4951You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4952dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4953@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4954all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4955
4956@kindex show print address
4957@item show print address
4958Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4959@end table
4960
4961When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4962closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4963identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4964source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4965@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4966you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4967it prints a symbolic address:
4968
4969@table @code
4970@kindex set print symbol-filename
4971@item set print symbol-filename on
4972Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4973symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4974
4975@item set print symbol-filename off
4976Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4977default.
4978
4979@kindex show print symbol-filename
4980@item show print symbol-filename
4981Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4982line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4983@end table
4984
4985Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4986numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4987number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4988
4989Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4990printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4991
4992@table @code
4993@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4994@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4995Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4996offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 4997@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
4998to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4999
5000@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5001@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5002Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5003symbolic address.
5004@end table
5005
5006@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5007@cindex pointer, finding referent
5008If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5009@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5010and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5011@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5012For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5013at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5014
5015@example
5016(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5017(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5018$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5019@end example
5020
5021@quotation
5022@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5023does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5024the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5025@end quotation
5026
5027Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5028
5029@table @code
5030@kindex set print array
5031@item set print array
5032@itemx set print array on
5033Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5034but uses more space. The default is off.
5035
5036@item set print array off
5037Return to compressed format for arrays.
5038
5039@kindex show print array
5040@item show print array
5041Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5042arrays.
5043
5044@kindex set print elements
5045@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5046Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5047If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5048printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5049This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5050When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5051Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5052
5053@kindex show print elements
5054@item show print elements
5055Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5056If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5057
5058@kindex set print null-stop
5059@item set print null-stop
5060Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5061@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5062contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5063The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5064
5065@kindex set print pretty
5066@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5067Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5068per line, like this:
5069
5070@smallexample
5071@group
5072$1 = @{
5073 next = 0x0,
5074 flags = @{
5075 sweet = 1,
5076 sour = 1
5077 @},
5078 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5079@}
5080@end group
5081@end smallexample
5082
5083@item set print pretty off
5084Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5085
5086@smallexample
5087@group
5088$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5089meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5090@end group
5091@end smallexample
5092
5093@noindent
5094This is the default format.
5095
5096@kindex show print pretty
5097@item show print pretty
5098Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5099
5100@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5101@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5102Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5103@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5104character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5105best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5106high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5107
5108@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5109Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5110international character sets, and is the default.
5111
5112@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5113@item show print sevenbit-strings
5114Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5115
5116@kindex set print union
5117@item set print union on
5d161b24 5118Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5119is the default setting.
5120
5121@item set print union off
5122Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5123
5124@kindex show print union
5125@item show print union
5126Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5127structures.
5128
5129For example, given the declarations
5130
5131@smallexample
5132typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5133typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5134typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5135 Bug_forms;
5136
5137struct thing @{
5138 Species it;
5139 union @{
5140 Tree_forms tree;
5141 Bug_forms bug;
5142 @} form;
5143@};
5144
5145struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5146@end smallexample
5147
5148@noindent
5149with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5150
5151@smallexample
5152$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5153@end smallexample
5154
5155@noindent
5156and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5157
5158@smallexample
5159$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5160@end smallexample
5161@end table
5162
c906108c
SS
5163@need 1000
5164@noindent
b37052ae 5165These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5166
5167@table @code
5168@cindex demangling
5169@kindex set print demangle
5170@item set print demangle
5171@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5172Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5173(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5174linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5175
5176@kindex show print demangle
5177@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5178Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5179
5180@kindex set print asm-demangle
5181@item set print asm-demangle
5182@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5183Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5184in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5185The default is off.
5186
5187@kindex show print asm-demangle
5188@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5189Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5190or demangled form.
5191
5192@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5193@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5194@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5195@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5196Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5197represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5198
5199@table @code
5200@item auto
5201Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5202
5203@item gnu
b37052ae 5204Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5205This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5206
5207@item hp
b37052ae 5208Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5209
5210@item lucid
b37052ae 5211Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5212
5213@item arm
b37052ae 5214Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5215@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5216debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5217require further enhancement to permit that.
5218
5219@end table
5220If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5221
5222@kindex show demangle-style
5223@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5224Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5225
5226@kindex set print object
5227@item set print object
5228@itemx set print object on
5229When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5230(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5231the virtual function table.
5232
5233@item set print object off
5234Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5235virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5236
5237@kindex show print object
5238@item show print object
5239Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5240
5241@kindex set print static-members
5242@item set print static-members
5243@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5244Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5245
5246@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5247Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5248
5249@kindex show print static-members
5250@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5251Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5252
5253@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5254@kindex set print vtbl
5255@item set print vtbl
5256@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5257Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5258(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5259ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5260
5261@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5262Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5263
5264@kindex show print vtbl
5265@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5266Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5267@end table
c906108c 5268
6d2ebf8b 5269@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5270@section Value history
5271
5272@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5273Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5274@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5275Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5276(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5277When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5278since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5279symbol table.
5280
5281@cindex @code{$}
5282@cindex @code{$$}
5283@cindex history number
5284The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5285refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5286@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5287printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5288history number.
5289
5290To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5291history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5292remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5293the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5294@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5295is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5296@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5297
5298For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5299want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5300
5301@example
5302p *$
5303@end example
5304
5305If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5306to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5307
5308@example
5309p *$.next
5310@end example
5311
5312@noindent
5313You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5314command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5315
5316Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5317@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5318
5319@example
5320print x
5321set x=5
5322@end example
5323
5324@noindent
5325then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5326remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5327
5328@table @code
5329@kindex show values
5330@item show values
5331Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5332This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5333values} does not change the history.
5334
5335@item show values @var{n}
5336Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5337
5338@item show values +
5339Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5340values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5341@end table
5342
5343Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5344same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5345
6d2ebf8b 5346@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5347@section Convenience variables
5348
5349@cindex convenience variables
5350@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5351@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5352exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5353setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5354of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5355
5356Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5357@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5358the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5359(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5360by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5361
5362You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5363expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5364For example:
5365
5366@example
5367set $foo = *object_ptr
5368@end example
5369
5370@noindent
5371would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5372@code{object_ptr}.
5373
5374Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5375value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5376value with another assignment at any time.
5377
5378Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5379variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5380that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5381variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5382
5383@table @code
5384@kindex show convenience
5385@item show convenience
5386Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5387Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5388@end table
5389
5390One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5391incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5392a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5393
5394@example
5395set $i = 0
5396print bar[$i++]->contents
5397@end example
5398
d4f3574e
SS
5399@noindent
5400Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5401
5402Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5403values likely to be useful.
5404
5405@table @code
41afff9a 5406@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5407@item $_
5408The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5409the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5410commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5411set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5412and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5413except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5414to the type of @code{$__}.
5415
41afff9a 5416@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5417@item $__
5418The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5419to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5420to match the format in which the data was printed.
5421
5422@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5423@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5424The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5425the program being debugged terminates.
5426@end table
5427
53a5351d
JM
5428On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5429begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5430name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5431
6d2ebf8b 5432@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5433@section Registers
5434
5435@cindex registers
5436You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5437with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5438for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5439your machine.
5440
5441@table @code
5442@kindex info registers
5443@item info registers
5444Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5445registers (in the selected stack frame).
5446
5447@kindex info all-registers
5448@cindex floating point registers
5449@item info all-registers
5450Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5451registers.
5452
5453@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5454Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5455As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5456the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5457the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5458@end table
5459
5460@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5461expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5462architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5463@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5464the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5465pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5466register that contains the processor status. For example,
5467you could print the program counter in hex with
5468
5469@example
5470p/x $pc
5471@end example
5472
5473@noindent
5474or print the instruction to be executed next with
5475
5476@example
5477x/i $pc
5478@end example
5479
5480@noindent
5481or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5482one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5483memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5484stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5485stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5486regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5487see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5488
5489@example
5490set $sp += 4
5491@end example
5492
5493Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5494your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5495so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5496shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5497registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5498can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5499is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5500
5501@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5502integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5503special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5504registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5505to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5506(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5507@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5508
5509Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5510means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5511the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5512sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5513coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5514programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5515cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5516that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5517prints the data in both formats.
5518
5519Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5520(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5521value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5522were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5523true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5524frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5525
5526However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5527code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5528@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5529frame makes no difference.
5530
6d2ebf8b 5531@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5532@section Floating point hardware
5533@cindex floating point
5534
5535Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5536you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5537
5538@table @code
5539@kindex info float
5540@item info float
5541Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5542point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5543floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5544the ARM and x86 machines.
5545@end table
c906108c 5546
29e57380
C
5547@node Memory Region Attributes
5548@section Memory Region Attributes
5549@cindex memory region attributes
5550
5551@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5552required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5553to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5554use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5555
5556Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5557memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5558accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5559been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5560all memory.
5561
5562When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5563to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5564
5565@table @code
5566@kindex mem
5567@item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5568Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5569with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5570
5571@kindex delete mem
5572@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5573Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5574
5575@kindex disable mem
5576@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5577Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5578A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5579It may be enabled again later.
5580
5581@kindex enable mem
5582@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5583Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5584
5585@kindex info mem
5586@item info mem
5587Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5588for each region.
5589
5590@table @emph
5591@item Memory Region Number
5592@item Enabled or Disabled.
5593Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5594Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5595
5596@item Lo Address
5597The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5598
5599@item Hi Address
5600The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5601
5602@item Attributes
5603The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5604@end table
5605@end table
5606
5607
5608@subsection Attributes
5609
5610@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5611The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5612write accesses to a memory region.
5613
5614While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5615memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5616etc. from accessing memory.
5617
5618@table @code
5619@item ro
5620Memory is read only.
5621@item wo
5622Memory is write only.
5623@item rw
5624Memory is read/write (default).
5625@end table
5626
5627@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5628The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5629accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5630require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5631specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5632
5633@table @code
5634@item 8
5635Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5636@item 16
5637Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5638@item 32
5639Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5640@item 64
5641Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5642@end table
5643
5644@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5645@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5646@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5647@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5648@c
5649@c @table @code
5650@c @item hwbreak
5651@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5652@c @item swbreak (default)
5653@c @end table
5654
5655@subsubsection Data Cache
5656The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5657memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5658protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5659does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5660registers.
5661
5662@table @code
5663@item cache
5664Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5665@item nocache (default)
5666Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5667@end table
5668
5669@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5670@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5671@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5672@c
5673@c @table @code
5674@c @item verify
5675@c @item noverify (default)
5676@c @end table
5677
b37052ae
EZ
5678@node Tracepoints
5679@chapter Tracepoints
5680@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5681@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5682
5683@cindex tracepoints
5684In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5685the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5686anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5687depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5688might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5689fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5690to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5691
5692Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5693specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5694arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5695Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5696those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5697expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5698for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5699a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5700in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5701values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5702unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5703
5704The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
5705targets. @xref{Targets}.
5706
5707This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5708
5709@menu
5710* Set Tracepoints::
5711* Analyze Collected Data::
5712* Tracepoint Variables::
5713@end menu
5714
5715@node Set Tracepoints
5716@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5717
5718Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5719tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5720tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5721breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5722one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5723tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5724work on.
5725
5726For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5727of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5728it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5729local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5730commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5731tracepoint was hit.
5732
5733This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5734conditions and actions.
5735
5736@menu
5737* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5738* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5739* Tracepoint Passcounts::
5740* Tracepoint Actions::
5741* Listing Tracepoints::
5742* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5743@end menu
5744
5745@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5746@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5747
5748@table @code
5749@cindex set tracepoint
5750@kindex trace
5751@item trace
5752The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5753Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5754the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5755defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5756debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5757program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5758doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5759cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5760running.
5761
5762Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5763
5764@smallexample
5765(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5766
5767(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5768
5769(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5770
5771(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5772
5773(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5774@end smallexample
5775
5776@noindent
5777You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5778
5779@vindex $tpnum
5780@cindex last tracepoint number
5781@cindex recent tracepoint number
5782@cindex tracepoint number
5783The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5784of the most recently set tracepoint.
5785
5786@kindex delete tracepoint
5787@cindex tracepoint deletion
5788@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5789Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5790default is to delete all tracepoints.
5791
5792Examples:
5793
5794@smallexample
5795(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5796
5797(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5798@end smallexample
5799
5800@noindent
5801You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5802@end table
5803
5804@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5805@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5806
5807@table @code
5808@kindex disable tracepoint
5809@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5810Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5811@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5812the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5813a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5814
5815@kindex enable tracepoint
5816@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5817Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5818tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5819run.
5820@end table
5821
5822@node Tracepoint Passcounts
5823@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5824
5825@table @code
5826@kindex passcount
5827@cindex tracepoint pass count
5828@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5829Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5830automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5831@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5832the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5833@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5834passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5835given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5836user.
5837
5838Examples:
5839
5840@smallexample
5841(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of tracepoint 2
5842
5843(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
5844 // most recently defined tracepoint.
5845(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5846(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5847(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5848(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5849(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5850(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
5851 // executed 3 times OR when bar has
5852 // been executed 2 times
5853 // OR when baz has been executed 1 time.
5854@end smallexample
5855@end table
5856
5857@node Tracepoint Actions
5858@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5859
5860@table @code
5861@kindex actions
5862@cindex tracepoint actions
5863@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5864This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5865tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5866specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5867recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5868@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5869actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5870terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5871far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5872@code{while-stepping}.
5873
5874@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5875To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5876and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5877
5878@smallexample
5879(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5880
5881(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times and collect data
5882
5883(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
5884@end smallexample
5885
5886In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5887commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5888hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5889following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5890followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5891@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5892@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5893@code{end} command.
5894
5895@smallexample
5896(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5897(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5898Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
5899> collect bar,baz
5900> collect $regs
5901> while-stepping 12
5902 > collect $fp, $sp
5903 > end
5904end
5905@end smallexample
5906
5907@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
5908@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
5909Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
5910This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
5911In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
5912special arguments are supported:
5913
5914@table @code
5915@item $regs
5916collect all registers
5917
5918@item $args
5919collect all function arguments
5920
5921@item $locals
5922collect all local variables.
5923@end table
5924
5925You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
5926with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
5927arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
5928
f5c37c66
EZ
5929The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
5930particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
5931
b37052ae
EZ
5932@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
5933@item while-stepping @var{n}
5934Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
5935new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
5936followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
5937its own @code{end} command):
5938
5939@smallexample
5940> while-stepping 12
5941 > collect $regs, myglobal
5942 > end
5943>
5944@end smallexample
5945
5946@noindent
5947You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
5948@code{stepping}.
5949@end table
5950
5951@node Listing Tracepoints
5952@subsection Listing Tracepoints
5953
5954@table @code
5955@kindex info tracepoints
5956@cindex information about tracepoints
5957@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5958Display information the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify a
5959tracepoint number displays information about all the tracepoints
5960defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
5961shown:
5962
5963@itemize @bullet
5964@item
5965its number
5966@item
5967whether it is enabled or disabled
5968@item
5969its address
5970@item
5971its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
5972@item
5973its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
5974@item
5975where in the source files is the tracepoint set
5976@item
5977its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
5978@end itemize
5979
5980@smallexample
5981(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
5982Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
59831 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
59842 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in gdb_test at gdb_test.c:375
59853 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in collect_data at ../foo.c:1741
5986(@value{GDBP})
5987@end smallexample
5988
5989@noindent
5990This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
5991@end table
5992
5993@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5994@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5995
5996@table @code
5997@kindex tstart
5998@cindex start a new trace experiment
5999@cindex collected data discarded
6000@item tstart
6001This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6002begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6003the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6004experiment.
6005
6006@kindex tstop
6007@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6008@item tstop
6009This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6010stops collecting data.
6011
6012@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6013automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6014(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6015
6016@kindex tstatus
6017@cindex status of trace data collection
6018@cindex trace experiment, status of
6019@item tstatus
6020This command displays the status of the current trace data
6021collection.
6022@end table
6023
6024Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6025
6026@smallexample
6027(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6028(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6029Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6030> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6031> while-stepping 11
6032 > collect $regs
6033 > end
6034> end
6035(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6036 [time passes @dots{}]
6037(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6038@end smallexample
6039
6040
6041@node Analyze Collected Data
6042@section Using the collected data
6043
6044After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6045for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6046collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6047snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6048consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6049examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6050specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6051snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6052registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6053rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6054debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6055(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6056behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6057when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6058the buffer will fail.
6059
6060@menu
6061* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6062* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6063* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6064@end menu
6065
6066@node tfind
6067@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6068
6069@kindex tfind
6070@cindex select trace snapshot
6071@cindex find trace snapshot
6072The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6073@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6074counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6075snapshot is selected.
6076
6077Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6078
6079@table @code
6080@item tfind start
6081Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6082@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6083
6084@item tfind none
6085Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6086
6087@item tfind end
6088Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6089
6090@item tfind
6091No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6092
6093@item tfind -
6094Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6095retracing earlier steps.
6096
6097@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6098Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6099proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6100argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6101for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6102
6103@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6104Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6105program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6106snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6107snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6108
6109@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6110Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6111addresses.
6112
6113@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6114Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6115@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6116
6117@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6118Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6119the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6120that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6121trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6122next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6123@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6124stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6125@end table
6126
6127The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6128designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6129instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6130snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6131trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6132simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6133snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6134@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6135The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6136for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6137no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6138(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6139no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6140tracepoint as the current one.
6141
6142In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6143these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6144scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6145you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6146registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6147
6148@smallexample
6149(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6150(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6151> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6152 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6153> tfind
6154> end
6155
6156Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6157Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6158Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6159Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6160Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6161Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6162Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6163Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6164Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6165Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6166Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6167@end smallexample
6168
6169Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6170the buffer:
6171
6172@smallexample
6173(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6174(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6175> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6176> tfind line
6177> end
6178
6179Frame 0, X = 1
6180Frame 7, X = 2
6181Frame 13, X = 255
6182@end smallexample
6183
6184@node tdump
6185@subsection @code{tdump}
6186@kindex tdump
6187@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6188@cindex tracepoint data, display
6189
6190This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6191the current trace snapshot.
6192
6193@smallexample
6194(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6195(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6196Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6197> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6198> end
6199
6200(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6201
6202(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6203#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6204at gdb_test.c:444
6205444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6206
6207(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6208Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6209d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6210d1 0x18 24
6211d2 0x80 128
6212d3 0x33 51
6213d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6214d5 0x22 34
6215d6 0xe0 224
6216d7 0x380035 3670069
6217a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6218a1 0x3000668 50333288
6219a2 0x100 256
6220a3 0x322000 3284992
6221a4 0x3000698 50333336
6222a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6223fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6224sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6225ps 0x0 0
6226pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6227fpcontrol 0x0 0
6228fpstatus 0x0 0
6229fpiaddr 0x0 0
6230p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6231p1 = (void *) 0x11
6232p2 = (void *) 0x22
6233p3 = (void *) 0x33
6234p4 = (void *) 0x44
6235p5 = (void *) 0x55
6236p6 = (void *) 0x66
6237gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6238
6239(@value{GDBP})
6240@end smallexample
6241
6242@node save-tracepoints
6243@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6244@kindex save-tracepoints
6245@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6246
6247This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6248their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6249suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6250tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6251Files}).
6252
6253@node Tracepoint Variables
6254@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6255@cindex tracepoint variables
6256@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6257
6258@table @code
6259@vindex $trace_frame
6260@item (int) $trace_frame
6261The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6262snapshot is selected.
6263
6264@vindex $tracepoint
6265@item (int) $tracepoint
6266The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6267
6268@vindex $trace_line
6269@item (int) $trace_line
6270The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6271
6272@vindex $trace_file
6273@item (char []) $trace_file
6274The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6275
6276@vindex $trace_func
6277@item (char []) $trace_func
6278The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6279@end table
6280
6281Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6282use @code{output} instead.
6283
6284Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6285stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6286data.
6287
6288@smallexample
6289(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6290
6291(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6292> output $trace_file
6293> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6294> tfind
6295> end
6296@end smallexample
6297
6d2ebf8b 6298@node Languages
c906108c
SS
6299@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6300@cindex languages
6301
c906108c
SS
6302Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6303rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6304dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6305Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 6306represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 6307@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
6308
6309@cindex working language
6310Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6311allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6312native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6313consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6314language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6315language}.
6316
6317@menu
6318* Setting:: Switching between source languages
6319* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 6320* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
6321* Support:: Supported languages
6322@end menu
6323
6d2ebf8b 6324@node Setting
c906108c
SS
6325@section Switching between source languages
6326
6327There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6328set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6329@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6330defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6331used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6332are printed, etc.
6333
6334In addition to the working language, every source file that
6335@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6336file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6337source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6338language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 6339controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 6340show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
6341set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6342set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6343Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
6344
6345This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 6346as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
6347another language. In that case, make the
6348program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6349@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6350program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6351
6352@menu
6353* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6354* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6355* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6356@end menu
6357
6d2ebf8b 6358@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
6359@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6360
6361If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6362@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6363
6364@table @file
6365
6366@item .c
6367C source file
6368
6369@item .C
6370@itemx .cc
6371@itemx .cp
6372@itemx .cpp
6373@itemx .cxx
6374@itemx .c++
b37052ae 6375C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
6376
6377@item .f
6378@itemx .F
6379Fortran source file
6380
c906108c
SS
6381@item .ch
6382@itemx .c186
6383@itemx .c286
96a2c332 6384CHILL source file
c906108c 6385
c906108c
SS
6386@item .mod
6387Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
6388
6389@item .s
6390@itemx .S
6391Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6392@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6393@end table
6394
6395In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6396extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6397
6d2ebf8b 6398@node Manually
c906108c
SS
6399@subsection Setting the working language
6400
6401If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6402expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6403your program.
6404
6405@kindex set language
6406If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6407command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 6408a language, such as
c906108c 6409@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
6410For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6411
c906108c
SS
6412Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6413language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6414to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6415source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6416languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6417source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6418command such as:
6419
6420@example
6421print a = b + c
6422@end example
6423
6424@noindent
6425might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6426@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6427printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6428@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 6429
6d2ebf8b 6430@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
6431@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6432
6433To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6434@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6435then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6436frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6437working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6438frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6439or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6440does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6441not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6442
6443This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6444entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6445written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6446a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6447case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6448
6d2ebf8b 6449@node Show
c906108c 6450@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
6451
6452The following commands help you find out which language is the
6453working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6454
6455@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
6456@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6457@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
6458@table @code
6459@item show language
6460Display the current working language. This is the
6461language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6462build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6463
6464@item info frame
5d161b24 6465Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 6466working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 6467@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6468information listed here.
6469
6470@item info source
6471Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 6472@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6473information listed here.
6474@end table
6475
6476In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6477not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6478with a language explicitly:
6479
6480@kindex set extension-language
6481@kindex info extensions
6482@table @code
6483@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6484Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6485the source language @var{language}.
6486
6487@item info extensions
6488List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6489@end table
6490
6d2ebf8b 6491@node Checks
c906108c
SS
6492@section Type and range checking
6493
6494@quotation
6495@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6496checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6497section documents the intended facilities.
6498@end quotation
6499@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6500
6501Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6502errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6503checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
6504sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
6505these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
6506by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
6507errors when your program is running.
6508
6509@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
6510Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
6511can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
6512the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
6513@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
6514your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
6515for the default settings of supported languages.
6516
6517@menu
6518* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
6519* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
6520@end menu
6521
6522@cindex type checking
6523@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 6524@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
6525@subsection An overview of type checking
6526
6527Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
6528arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
6529otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
6530errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
6531
6532@smallexample
65331 + 2 @result{} 3
6534@exdent but
6535@error{} 1 + 2.3
6536@end smallexample
6537
6538The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
6539type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
6540
5d161b24
DB
6541For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
6542@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
6543to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
6544or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
6545but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
6546these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
6547also issues a warning.
6548
5d161b24
DB
6549Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
6550related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
6551For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
6552a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
6553with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
6554the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
6555
6556Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
6557instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
6558operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
6559represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
6560operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
6561details on specific languages.
6562
6563@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
6564
d4f3574e 6565@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
6566@kindex set check type
6567@kindex show check type
6568@table @code
6569@item set check type auto
6570Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
6571@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6572each language.
6573
6574@item set check type on
6575@itemx set check type off
6576Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6577current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
6578match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 6579evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
6580message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
6581
6582@item set check type warn
6583Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
6584evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
6585be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
6586numbers and structures.
6587
6588@item show type
5d161b24 6589Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6590is setting it automatically.
6591@end table
6592
6593@cindex range checking
6594@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 6595@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
6596@subsection An overview of range checking
6597
6598In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
6599bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
6600checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
6601computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
6602not exceed the bounds of the array.
6603
6604For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
6605@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
6606always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
6607warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
6608
6609A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
6610array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
6611of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
6612error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
6613result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
6614the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
6615
6616@example
6617@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
6618@end example
6619
6620This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
6621specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
6622Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
6623
6624@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
6625
d4f3574e 6626@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
6627@kindex set check range
6628@kindex show check range
6629@table @code
6630@item set check range auto
6631Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
6632@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6633each language.
6634
6635@item set check range on
6636@itemx set check range off
6637Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6638current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
6639match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
6640then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
6641
6642@item set check range warn
6643Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
6644but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
6645expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
6646memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
6647systems).
6648
6649@item show range
6650Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
6651being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
6652@end table
c906108c 6653
6d2ebf8b 6654@node Support
c906108c 6655@section Supported languages
c906108c 6656
b37052ae 6657@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 6658@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
6659Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
6660language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
6661and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
6662,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
6663language.
6664
6665The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
6666supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
6667tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
6668@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
6669formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
6670books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
6671language reference or tutorial.
6672
c906108c 6673@menu
b37052ae 6674* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 6675* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 6676* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
6677@end menu
6678
6d2ebf8b 6679@node C
b37052ae 6680@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 6681
b37052ae
EZ
6682@cindex C and C@t{++}
6683@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 6684
b37052ae 6685Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
6686to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
6687together.
6688
41afff9a
EZ
6689@cindex C@t{++}
6690@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
6691@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
6692The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
6693compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
6694effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
6695C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6696compiler (@code{aCC}).
6697
b37052ae 6698For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
6699format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
6700command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
6701@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
6702CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 6703
c906108c 6704@menu
b37052ae
EZ
6705* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
6706* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
6707* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
6708* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
6709* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 6710* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 6711* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 6712@end menu
c906108c 6713
6d2ebf8b 6714@node C Operators
b37052ae 6715@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 6716
b37052ae 6717@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
6718
6719Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6720@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 6721often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 6722
b37052ae 6723For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
6724
6725@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 6726
c906108c 6727@item
c906108c 6728@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 6729specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
6730
6731@item
d4f3574e
SS
6732@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
6733@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
6734
6735@item
53a5351d 6736@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
6737
6738@item
6739@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 6740
c906108c
SS
6741@end itemize
6742
6743@noindent
6744The following operators are supported. They are listed here
6745in order of increasing precedence:
6746
6747@table @code
6748@item ,
6749The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
6750are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
6751expression being the last expression evaluated.
6752
6753@item =
6754Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
6755assigned. Defined on scalar types.
6756
6757@item @var{op}=
6758Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
6759and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 6760@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
6761@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
6762@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
6763
6764@item ?:
6765The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
6766of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
6767integral type.
6768
6769@item ||
6770Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6771
6772@item &&
6773Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6774
6775@item |
6776Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6777
6778@item ^
6779Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6780
6781@item &
6782Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6783
6784@item ==@r{, }!=
6785Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
6786expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
6787
6788@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
6789Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
6790Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6791and non-zero for true.
6792
6793@item <<@r{, }>>
6794left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6795
6796@item @@
6797The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6798
6799@item +@r{, }-
6800Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6801pointer types.
6802
6803@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6804Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6805defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6806integral types.
6807
6808@item ++@r{, }--
6809Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6810operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6811when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6812operation takes place.
6813
6814@item *
6815Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6816@code{++}.
6817
6818@item &
6819Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6820
b37052ae
EZ
6821For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6822allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 6823(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 6824where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 6825stored.
c906108c
SS
6826
6827@item -
6828Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6829precedence as @code{++}.
6830
6831@item !
6832Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6833@code{++}.
6834
6835@item ~
6836Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6837@code{++}.
6838
6839
6840@item .@r{, }->
6841Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6842@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6843pointer based on the stored type information.
6844Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6845
c906108c
SS
6846@item .*@r{, }->*
6847Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
6848
6849@item []
6850Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6851@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6852
6853@item ()
6854Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6855
c906108c 6856@item ::
b37052ae 6857C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 6858and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
6859
6860@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6861Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6862(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6863above.
c906108c
SS
6864@end table
6865
c906108c
SS
6866If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6867attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6868predefined meaning.
c906108c 6869
c906108c 6870@menu
5d161b24 6871* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
6872@end menu
6873
6d2ebf8b 6874@node C Constants
b37052ae 6875@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6876
b37052ae 6877@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6878
b37052ae 6879@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 6880following ways:
c906108c
SS
6881
6882@itemize @bullet
6883@item
6884Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6885specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6886a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6887@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6888@code{long} value.
6889
6890@item
6891Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6892point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6893exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6894@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6895sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
6896A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6897@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6898the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6899a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6900constant.
c906108c
SS
6901
6902@item
6903Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6904integral equivalents.
6905
6906@item
6907Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6908(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6909(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6910be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6911the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6912of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6913@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6914@samp{\n} for newline.
6915
6916@item
96a2c332
SS
6917String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6918double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6919above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6920a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6921characters.
c906108c
SS
6922
6923@item
6924Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6925to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6926
6927@item
6928Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6929and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6930integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6931and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6932@end itemize
6933
c906108c 6934@menu
5d161b24
DB
6935* C plus plus expressions::
6936* C Defaults::
6937* C Checks::
c906108c 6938
5d161b24 6939* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
6940@end menu
6941
6d2ebf8b 6942@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
6943@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
6944
6945@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
6946@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
6947
6948@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
6949@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
6950@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
6951@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
6952@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
6953@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
6954@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
6955@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
6956@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6957@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6958@c periodically whether this has happened...
6959@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
6960@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
6961proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
6962additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6963special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6964@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6965symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6966you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6967extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 6968@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6969support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6970@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6971
6972@enumerate
6973
6974@cindex member functions
6975@item
6976Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6977
6978@example
6979count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6980@end example
6981
41afff9a 6982@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 6983@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6984@item
6985While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6986expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6987that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 6988pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 6989
c906108c 6990@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6991@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 6992@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6993@item
6994You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6995call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6996perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6997calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6998in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6999default arguments.
7000
7001It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
7002promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
7003class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
7004functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
7005number of function arguments.
7006
7007Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
7008@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 7009,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 7010
d4f3574e 7011You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
7012explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
7013@smallexample
7014p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
7015@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7016
c906108c 7017The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 7018see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 7019
c906108c
SS
7020@cindex reference declarations
7021@item
b37052ae
EZ
7022@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7023them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
7024dereferenced.
7025
7026In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7027reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7028avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7029The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7030you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7031
7032@item
b37052ae 7033@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
7034expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7035one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7036necessary, for example in an expression like
7037@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 7038resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7039debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7040@end enumerate
7041
b37052ae 7042In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
7043calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7044objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7045invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 7046
6d2ebf8b 7047@node C Defaults
b37052ae 7048@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 7049
b37052ae 7050@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 7051
c906108c
SS
7052If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7053both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 7054C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 7055selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
7056
7057If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7058recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7059@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 7060these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
7061@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7062for further details.
7063
c906108c
SS
7064@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7065@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7066@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 7067
6d2ebf8b 7068@node C Checks
b37052ae 7069@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 7070
b37052ae 7071@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 7072
b37052ae 7073By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
7074is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7075considers two variables type equivalent if:
7076
7077@itemize @bullet
7078@item
7079The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7080enumerated tag.
7081
7082@item
7083The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7084declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7085
7086@ignore
7087@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7088@c FIXME--beers?
7089@item
7090The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7091declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7092compilers.)
7093@end ignore
7094@end itemize
7095
7096Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7097indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7098that is not itself an array.
c906108c 7099
6d2ebf8b 7100@node Debugging C
c906108c 7101@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
7102
7103The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7104the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
7105inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7106appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
7107
7108The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7109with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7110,Expressions}.
7111
c906108c 7112@menu
5d161b24 7113* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
7114@end menu
7115
6d2ebf8b 7116@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 7117@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7118
b37052ae 7119@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7120
b37052ae
EZ
7121Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7122designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
7123
7124@table @code
7125@cindex break in overloaded functions
7126@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7127When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7128@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7129you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7130
b37052ae 7131@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7132@item rbreak @var{regex}
7133Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7134breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7135classes.
7136@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7137
b37052ae 7138@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
7139@item catch throw
7140@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 7141Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
7142Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7143
7144@cindex inheritance
7145@item ptype @var{typename}
7146Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7147@var{typename}.
7148@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7149
b37052ae 7150@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
7151@item set print demangle
7152@itemx show print demangle
7153@itemx set print asm-demangle
7154@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
7155Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7156displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
7157@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7158
7159@item set print object
7160@itemx show print object
7161Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7162@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7163
7164@item set print vtbl
7165@itemx show print vtbl
7166Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7167@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 7168(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 7169ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
7170
7171@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 7172@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 7173@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 7174Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
7175is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7176and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 7177using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 7178expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
7179message.
7180
7181@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 7182Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
7183overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7184chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7185symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7186overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7187searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7188argument types.
c906108c
SS
7189
7190@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7191You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 7192the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
7193@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7194also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7195available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7196@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7197@end table
c906108c 7198
6d2ebf8b 7199@node Modula-2
c906108c 7200@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 7201
d4f3574e 7202@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
7203
7204The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7205output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7206developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7207attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7208to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7209table.
7210
7211@cindex expressions in Modula-2
7212@menu
7213* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7214* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7215* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7216* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7217* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7218* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7219* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7220* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7221@end menu
7222
6d2ebf8b 7223@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
7224@subsubsection Operators
7225@cindex Modula-2 operators
7226
7227Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7228@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7229often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7230following definitions hold:
7231
7232@itemize @bullet
7233
7234@item
7235@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7236their subranges.
7237
7238@item
7239@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7240
7241@item
7242@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7243
7244@item
7245@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7246@var{type}}.
7247
7248@item
7249@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7250
7251@item
7252@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7253
7254@item
7255@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7256@end itemize
7257
7258@noindent
7259The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7260increasing precedence:
7261
7262@table @code
7263@item ,
7264Function argument or array index separator.
7265
7266@item :=
7267Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7268@var{value}.
7269
7270@item <@r{, }>
7271Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7272types.
7273
7274@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 7275Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
7276on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7277set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7278
7279@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7280Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7281Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7282available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7283comment character.
7284
7285@item IN
7286Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7287Same precedence as @code{<}.
7288
7289@item OR
7290Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7291
7292@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 7293Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
7294
7295@item @@
7296The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7297
7298@item +@r{, }-
7299Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7300and difference on set types.
7301
7302@item *
7303Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7304on set types.
7305
7306@item /
7307Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7308types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7309
7310@item DIV@r{, }MOD
7311Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7312precedence as @code{*}.
7313
7314@item -
7315Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7316
7317@item ^
7318Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7319
7320@item NOT
7321Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7322@code{^}.
7323
7324@item .
7325@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7326precedence as @code{^}.
7327
7328@item []
7329Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7330
7331@item ()
7332Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7333as @code{^}.
7334
7335@item ::@r{, }.
7336@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7337@end table
7338
7339@quotation
7340@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7341treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7342@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7343@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7344@end quotation
7345
cb51c4e0 7346
6d2ebf8b 7347@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 7348@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 7349@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
7350
7351Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7352In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7353
7354@table @var
7355
7356@item a
7357represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7358
7359@item c
7360represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7361
7362@item i
7363represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7364
7365@item m
7366represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7367same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7368be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7369
7370@item n
7371represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7372
7373@item r
7374represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7375
7376@item t
7377represents a type.
7378
7379@item v
7380represents a variable.
7381
7382@item x
7383represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7384explanation of the function for details.
7385@end table
7386
7387All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7388
7389@table @code
7390@item ABS(@var{n})
7391Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7392
7393@item CAP(@var{c})
7394If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 7395equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
7396
7397@item CHR(@var{i})
7398Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7399
7400@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7401Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7402
7403@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7404Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7405new value.
7406
7407@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7408Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7409set.
7410
7411@item FLOAT(@var{i})
7412Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7413
7414@item HIGH(@var{a})
7415Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7416
7417@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7418Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7419
7420@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7421Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7422new value.
7423
7424@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7425Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7426there. Returns the new set.
7427
7428@item MAX(@var{t})
7429Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7430
7431@item MIN(@var{t})
7432Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7433
7434@item ODD(@var{i})
7435Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7436
7437@item ORD(@var{x})
7438Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
7439value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7440@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
7441integral, character and enumerated types.
7442
7443@item SIZE(@var{x})
7444Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7445
7446@item TRUNC(@var{r})
7447Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7448
7449@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7450Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7451@end table
7452
7453@quotation
7454@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7455@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7456an error.
7457@end quotation
7458
7459@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 7460@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
7461@subsubsection Constants
7462
7463@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7464ways:
7465
7466@itemize @bullet
7467
7468@item
7469Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7470expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7471rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7472trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7473
7474@item
7475Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7476decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7477then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7478@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7479digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7480digits.
7481
7482@item
7483Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7484like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 7485also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
7486followed by a @samp{C}.
7487
7488@item
7489String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7490pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7491Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 7492Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
7493sequences.
7494
7495@item
7496Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7497
7498@item
7499Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7500@code{FALSE}.
7501
7502@item
7503Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
7504
7505@item
7506Set constants are not yet supported.
7507@end itemize
7508
6d2ebf8b 7509@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
7510@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
7511@cindex Modula-2 defaults
7512
7513If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7514both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7515Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7516selected the working language.
7517
7518If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7519code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 7520working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
7521the language automatically}, for further details.
7522
6d2ebf8b 7523@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
7524@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
7525@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
7526
7527A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
7528This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
7529
7530@itemize @bullet
7531@item
7532Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
7533integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
7534debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
7535pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
7536through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
7537returned a pointer.)
7538
7539@item
7540C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
7541non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
7542escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
7543printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
7544
7545@item
7546The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
7547argument.
7548
7549@item
7550All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
7551@end itemize
7552
6d2ebf8b 7553@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
7554@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
7555@cindex Modula-2 checks
7556
7557@quotation
7558@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
7559range checking.
7560@end quotation
7561@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
7562
7563@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
7564
7565@itemize @bullet
7566@item
7567They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
7568@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
7569
7570@item
7571They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
7572@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
7573@end itemize
7574
7575As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
7576whose types are not equivalent is an error.
7577
7578Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7579index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
7580
6d2ebf8b 7581@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
7582@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7583@cindex scope
41afff9a 7584@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
7585@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
7586@ifinfo
41afff9a 7587@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7588@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
7589@end ifinfo
7590@iftex
41afff9a 7591@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7592@end iftex
7593
7594There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
7595(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
7596similar syntax:
7597
7598@example
7599
7600@var{module} . @var{id}
7601@var{scope} :: @var{id}
7602@end example
7603
7604@noindent
7605where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
7606@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
7607identifier within your program, except another module.
7608
7609Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
7610specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
7611found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
7612enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
7613
7614Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
7615the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
7616definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
7617an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
7618module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
7619@var{module}.
7620
6d2ebf8b 7621@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
7622@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7623
7624Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
7625Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 7626specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 7627@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 7628apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
7629analogue in Modula-2.
7630
7631The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 7632with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 7633intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 7634created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 7635address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 7636@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
7637
7638@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
7639In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
7640interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 7641
6d2ebf8b 7642@node Chill
cce74817
JM
7643@subsection Chill
7644
7645The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 7646from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
7647supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
7648likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7649table.
7650
d4f3574e
SS
7651@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
7652@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
7653This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
7654of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
7655
7656@menu
104c1213
JM
7657* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
7658* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 7659* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 7660* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 7661* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
7662@end menu
7663
6d2ebf8b 7664@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
7665@subsubsection How modes are displayed
7666
7667The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 7668with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
7669slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
7670provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
7671
7672@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
7673@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
7674@table @code
7675@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
7676@itemize @bullet
7677@item
7678@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
7679UINT, LONG, ULONG},
7680@item
5d161b24 7681@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 7682@item
5d161b24 7683@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
7684@item
7685@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
7686@smallexample
7687(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7688type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7689@end smallexample
7690If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
7691@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7692@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
7693@smallexample
7694@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
7695@end smallexample
7696where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
7697expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
7698@end itemize
7699
7700@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
7701A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 7702the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
7703@smallexample
7704(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7705type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
7706@end smallexample
7707
7708@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
7709@itemize @bullet
7710@item
d4f3574e 7711@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
7712followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
7713@item
7714@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
7715@end itemize
7716
7717@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
7718The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
7719<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
7720list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
7721the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
7722all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
7723
7724@ignore
7725@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
7726The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 7727type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
7728@end ignore
7729
5d161b24 7730@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7731@itemize @bullet
7732@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7733@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
7734@smallexample
7735@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
7736@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7737where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
7738@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7739@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
7740@smallexample
7741@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
7742@end smallexample
7743where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
7744@end itemize
7745
5d161b24 7746@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7747@itemize @bullet
7748@item
7749@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
7750@item
7751@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
7752@end itemize
7753
7754@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
7755Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
7756
7757@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
7758@itemize @bullet
7759@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7760@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
7761@smallexample
7762@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
7763@end smallexample
7764followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
7765mode
cce74817 7766@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7767@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
7768@smallexample
7769@code{BOOLS(<string
7770length>)}
7771@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7772@end itemize
7773
7774@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
7775The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
7776followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
7777@smallexample
7778(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
7779type = ARRAY (1:42)
7780 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
7781 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7782@end smallexample
7783
5d161b24 7784@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 7785The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
7786list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
7787of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
7788OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
7789of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
7790checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
7791always displays all variant fields.
7792@smallexample
7793(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7794type = STRUCT (
7795 as x,
7796 bs x,
7797 CASE bs OF
7798 (karli):
7799 cs a
7800 (ott):
7801 ds x
7802 ESAC
7803)
7804@end smallexample
7805@end table
7806
6d2ebf8b 7807@node Locations
cce74817
JM
7808@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7809
7810A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7811
7812A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
7813the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7814Chill programs. How values are specified
7815is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7816
7817The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7818display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 7819
cce74817
JM
7820@smallexample
7821set result := EXPR
7822@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
7823
7824@noindent
7825This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 7826is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
7827
7828Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7829value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 7830mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
7831represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7832value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 7833operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 7834
6d2ebf8b
SS
7835Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7836@smallexample
7837@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 7838(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
7839location>}
7840@end smallexample
7841@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7842specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7843the entry point.
cce74817
JM
7844
7845@ignore
7846Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7847fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7848the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
7849implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7850na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7851<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
7852@code{__proc_copy}.
7853
7854Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7855the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7856like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7857mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7858
7859Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 7860...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 7861definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
7862of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7863structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7864braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 7865on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 7866memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 7867all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 7868@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
7869stuff ???)
7870@smallexample
7871(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7872[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7873@end smallexample
7874@end ignore
7875
7876Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7877(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
7878certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7879and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7880
7881A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
7882location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7883name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7884have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7885checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 7886therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 7887
cce74817
JM
7888@smallexample
7889(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7890@end smallexample
7891
6d2ebf8b 7892@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
7893@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7894
7895Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7896more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
7897data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7898such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 7899constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 7900when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
7901(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7902the values behind these locations.
7903
d4f3574e 7904This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
7905operations are legal to be used with such values.
7906
7907@table @code
7908@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
7909Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7910For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 7911chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
7912@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7913@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 7914
5d161b24 7915@ignore
cce74817
JM
7916@itemize @bullet
7917@item
7918@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 7919programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7920@item
7921@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7922@item
7923@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7924@code{'M'})
7925@item
7926@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e 7927mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
b37052ae 7928comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
cce74817 7929@item
d4f3574e 7930@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 7931emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 7932procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
7933
7934@item
7935@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7936enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7937to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7938@item
7939@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7940programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7941@item
7942@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7943(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7944@end itemize
7945@end ignore
7946
7947@item Tuple Values
7948A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7949name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7950unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7951@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7952
cce74817
JM
7953@itemize @bullet
7954@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7955@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7956@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7957Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7958same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7959@end itemize
7960
7961@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
7962A string element value is specified by
7963@smallexample
7964@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7965@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7966where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7967value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7968the string.
7969
7970@item String Slice Value
7971A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7972spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7973expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7974@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7975The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7976string.
7977
7978@item Array Element Values
7979An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7980delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7981
7982@item Array Slice Values
7983An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7984@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7985@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7986arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7987which is part of the specified array.
7988
7989@item Structure Field Values
7990A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7991name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7992in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7993corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7994
7995@item Procedure Call Value
7996The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7997procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7998expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7999effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 8000
d4f3574e 8001Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 8002
6d2ebf8b
SS
8003Values of time mode locations appear as
8004@smallexample
8005@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
8006@end smallexample
8007
cce74817
JM
8008
8009@ignore
8010This is not implemented yet:
8011@item Built-in Value
8012@noindent
8013The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 8014
cce74817
JM
8015@table @code
8016@item @code{ADDR()}
8017@item @code{NUM()}
8018@item @code{PRED()}
8019@item @code{SUCC()}
8020@item @code{ABS()}
8021@item @code{CARD()}
8022@item @code{MAX()}
8023@item @code{MIN()}
8024@item @code{SIZE()}
8025@item @code{UPPER()}
8026@item @code{LOWER()}
8027@item @code{LENGTH()}
8028@item @code{SIN()}
8029@item @code{COS()}
8030@item @code{TAN()}
8031@item @code{ARCSIN()}
8032@item @code{ARCCOS()}
8033@item @code{ARCTAN()}
8034@item @code{EXP()}
8035@item @code{LN()}
8036@item @code{LOG()}
8037@item @code{SQRT()}
8038@end table
8039
8040For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8041chapter 1.6.
8042@end ignore
8043
8044@item Zero-adic Operator Value
8045The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8046current active process.
8047
8048@item Expression Values
8049The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 8050the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 8051incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 8052corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 8053causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 8054which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 8055operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 8056
cce74817
JM
8057@table @code
8058@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8059@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8060@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8061Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 8062
cce74817
JM
8063@item @code{=, /=}
8064Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 8065
cce74817 8066@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8067@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8068Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8069
cce74817 8070@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 8071@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 8072Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8073
cce74817
JM
8074@item @code{-}
8075Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 8076
cce74817
JM
8077@item @code{//}
8078String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 8079
cce74817
JM
8080@item @code{()}
8081String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 8082
cce74817
JM
8083@item @code{->}
8084Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8085address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8086location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 8087
cce74817 8088@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8089@itemx @code{AND}
8090@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8091Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 8092
cce74817 8093@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8094@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8095Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 8096
cce74817
JM
8097@item @code{IN}
8098Membership operator.
8099@end table
8100@end table
8101
6d2ebf8b 8102@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
8103@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8104
8105@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 8106of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 8107complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 8108equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
8109structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8110
8111Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8112index bounds and all built in procedures.
8113
8114Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 8115check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
8116operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8117functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8118language specification.
8119
cce74817
JM
8120All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8121off}.
8122
5d161b24 8123@ignore
53a5351d 8124@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
8125see last paragraph ?
8126@end ignore
8127
6d2ebf8b 8128@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
8129@subsubsection Chill defaults
8130
8131If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8132both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8133Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
8134selected the working language.
8135
8136If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8137code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 8138working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
8139the language automatically}, for further details.
8140
6d2ebf8b 8141@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8142@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8143
d4f3574e 8144The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8145symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8146program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8147does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8148program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8149(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8150file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8151
8152@cindex symbol names
8153@cindex names of symbols
8154@cindex quoting names
8155Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8156characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8157most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8158source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8159are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8160ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8161@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8162@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8163
8164@example
8165p 'foo.c'::x
8166@end example
8167
8168@noindent
8169looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8170
8171@table @code
8172@kindex info address
b37052ae 8173@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8174@item info address @var{symbol}
8175Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8176variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8177local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8178is always stored.
8179
8180Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8181at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8182the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8183
3d67e040 8184@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8185@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8186@item info symbol @var{addr}
8187Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8188If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8189nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8190
8191@example
8192(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8193_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8194@end example
8195
8196@noindent
8197This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8198it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8199
c906108c 8200@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8201@item whatis @var{expr}
8202Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8203actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8204assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8205@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8206
8207@item whatis
8208Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8209
8210@kindex ptype
8211@item ptype @var{typename}
8212Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8213the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8214@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8215@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8216
d4f3574e 8217@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8218@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8219Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8220differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8221of just the name of the type.
8222
8223For example, for this variable declaration:
8224
8225@example
8226struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8227@end example
8228
8229@noindent
8230the two commands give this output:
8231
8232@example
8233@group
8234(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8235type = struct complex
8236(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8237type = struct complex @{
8238 double real;
8239 double imag;
8240@}
8241@end group
8242@end example
8243
8244@noindent
8245As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8246the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8247
8248@kindex info types
8249@item info types @var{regexp}
8250@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8251Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8252(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8253complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8254@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8255names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8256information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8257
8258This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8259@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8260lists all source files where a type is defined.
8261
b37052ae
EZ
8262@kindex info scope
8263@cindex local variables
8264@item info scope @var{addr}
8265List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8266accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8267preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8268scope defined by that location. For example:
8269
8270@smallexample
8271(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8272Scope for command_line_handler:
8273Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8274Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8275Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8276Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8277Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8278Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8279Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8280@end smallexample
8281
f5c37c66
EZ
8282@noindent
8283This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8284during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8285collect}.
8286
c906108c
SS
8287@kindex info source
8288@item info source
8289Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8290the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8291it was written in.
8292
8293@kindex info sources
8294@item info sources
8295Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8296debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8297have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8298
8299@kindex info functions
8300@item info functions
8301Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8302
8303@item info functions @var{regexp}
8304Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8305whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8306Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8307include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8308start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8309that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8310@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8311
8312@kindex info variables
8313@item info variables
8314Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8315outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
8316
8317@item info variables @var{regexp}
8318Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8319variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8320@var{regexp}.
8321
8322@ignore
8323This was never implemented.
8324@kindex info methods
8325@item info methods
8326@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8327The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8328methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8329specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8330C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8331from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8332@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8333which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8334@end ignore
8335
c906108c
SS
8336@cindex reloading symbols
8337Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8338be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8339in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8340running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8341@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8342
8343@table @code
8344@kindex set symbol-reloading
8345@item set symbol-reloading on
8346Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8347object file with a particular name is seen again.
8348
8349@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8350Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8351same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8352running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8353should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8354may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8355several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8356name.
c906108c
SS
8357
8358@kindex show symbol-reloading
8359@item show symbol-reloading
8360Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8361@end table
c906108c 8362
c906108c
SS
8363@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8364@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8365Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8366declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8367@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8368source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8369another source file. The default is on.
8370
8371A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8372the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8373
8374@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8375Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8376is printed as follows:
8377@smallexample
8378@{<no data fields>@}
8379@end smallexample
8380
8381@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8382@item show opaque-type-resolution
8383Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8384
8385@kindex maint print symbols
8386@cindex symbol dump
8387@kindex maint print psymbols
8388@cindex partial symbol dump
8389@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8390@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8391@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8392Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8393These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8394symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8395symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8396collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8397only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8398command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8399use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8400symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8401files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8402@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8403required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8404@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8405@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8406@end table
8407
6d2ebf8b 8408@node Altering
c906108c
SS
8409@chapter Altering Execution
8410
8411Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8412find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8413correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8414experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8415program.
8416
8417For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
8418locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8419address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
8420
8421@menu
8422* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8423* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 8424* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
8425* Returning:: Returning from a function
8426* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8427* Patching:: Patching your program
8428@end menu
8429
6d2ebf8b 8430@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
8431@section Assignment to variables
8432
8433@cindex assignment
8434@cindex setting variables
8435To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8436@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8437
8438@example
8439print x=4
8440@end example
8441
8442@noindent
8443stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 8444value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
8445@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8446information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
8447
8448@kindex set variable
8449@cindex variables, setting
8450If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8451@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8452really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8453not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8454,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8455
c906108c
SS
8456If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8457appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8458variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8459to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8460program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8461a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8462command @code{set width}:
8463
8464@example
8465(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8466type = double
8467(@value{GDBP}) p width
8468$4 = 13
8469(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8470Invalid syntax in expression.
8471@end example
8472
8473@noindent
8474The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8475order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8476
8477@example
8478(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8479@end example
53a5351d 8480
c906108c
SS
8481Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8482with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8483@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8484your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8485to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8486the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8487
8488@example
8489@group
8490(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8491type = double
8492(@value{GDBP}) p g
8493$1 = 1
8494(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 8495(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
8496$2 = 1
8497(@value{GDBP}) r
8498The program being debugged has been started already.
8499Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8500Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
8501"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8502 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
8503(@value{GDBP}) show g
8504The current BFD target is "=4".
8505@end group
8506@end example
8507
8508@noindent
8509The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
8510@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
8511@code{g}, use
8512
8513@example
8514(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
8515@end example
c906108c
SS
8516
8517@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
8518freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
8519and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
8520same length or shorter.
8521@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
8522@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
8523
8524To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
8525construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
8526(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
8527to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
8528and representation in memory), and
8529
8530@example
8531set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
8532@end example
8533
8534@noindent
8535stores the value 4 into that memory location.
8536
6d2ebf8b 8537@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
8538@section Continuing at a different address
8539
8540Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
8541it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
8542an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
8543
8544@table @code
8545@kindex jump
8546@item jump @var{linespec}
8547Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
8548immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
8549source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
8550@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
8551in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
8552breakpoints}.
8553
8554The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
8555the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
8556register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
8557a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
8558be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
8559of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
8560confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
8561executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
8562well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
8563
8564@item jump *@var{address}
8565Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
8566@end table
8567
c906108c 8568@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
8569On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
8570command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
8571difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
8572changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
8573example,
c906108c
SS
8574
8575@example
8576set $pc = 0x485
8577@end example
8578
8579@noindent
8580makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
8581address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
8582@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
8583
8584The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
8585up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
8586that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
8587detail.
8588
c906108c 8589@c @group
6d2ebf8b 8590@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
8591@section Giving your program a signal
8592
8593@table @code
8594@kindex signal
8595@item signal @var{signal}
8596Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
8597signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
8598signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
8599SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
8600
8601Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
8602giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
8603a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
8604@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
8605signal.
8606
8607@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
8608after executing the command.
8609@end table
8610@c @end group
8611
8612Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
8613@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
8614causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
8615the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
8616passes the signal directly to your program.
8617
c906108c 8618
6d2ebf8b 8619@node Returning
c906108c
SS
8620@section Returning from a function
8621
8622@table @code
8623@cindex returning from a function
8624@kindex return
8625@item return
8626@itemx return @var{expression}
8627You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
8628command. If you give an
8629@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
8630value.
8631@end table
8632
8633When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
8634(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
8635discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
8636be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
8637
8638This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
8639frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
8640innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
8641specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
8642of functions.
8643
8644The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
8645program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
8646returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
8647and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
8648selected stack frame returns naturally.
8649
6d2ebf8b 8650@node Calling
c906108c
SS
8651@section Calling program functions
8652
8653@cindex calling functions
8654@kindex call
8655@table @code
8656@item call @var{expr}
8657Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
8658returned values.
8659@end table
8660
8661You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
8662execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
8663with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
8664is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 8665
c906108c
SS
8666For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
8667specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
8668calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
8669method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
8670that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 8671
6d2ebf8b 8672@node Patching
c906108c 8673@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 8674
c906108c
SS
8675@cindex patching binaries
8676@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 8677@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 8678
7a292a7a
SS
8679By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
8680executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
8681alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
8682patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
8683
8684If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
8685explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
8686want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
8687repairs.
8688
8689@table @code
8690@kindex set write
8691@item set write on
8692@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
8693If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
8694core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
8695off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
8696
8697If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
8698@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
8699write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
8700
8701@item show write
8702@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
8703Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
8704as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
8705@end table
8706
6d2ebf8b 8707@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
8708@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
8709
7a292a7a
SS
8710@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
8711both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
8712program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
8713@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
8714
8715@menu
8716* Files:: Commands to specify files
8717* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
8718@end menu
8719
6d2ebf8b 8720@node Files
c906108c 8721@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 8722
7a292a7a 8723@cindex symbol table
c906108c 8724@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
8725
8726You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
8727way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
8728@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
8729Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
8730
8731Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
8732@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
8733a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
8734to specify new files are useful.
8735
8736@table @code
8737@cindex executable file
8738@kindex file
8739@item file @var{filename}
8740Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
8741symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
8742executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
8743directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
8744@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
8745directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
8746to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8747and your program, using the @code{path} command.
8748
6d2ebf8b 8749On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
8750@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
8751@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
8752@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
8753descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
8754(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 8755@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 8756for more information.
c906108c
SS
8757
8758@item file
8759@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
8760has on both executable file and the symbol table.
8761
8762@kindex exec-file
8763@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8764Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
8765in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
8766if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
8767discard information on the executable file.
8768
8769@kindex symbol-file
8770@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8771Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
8772searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
8773table and program to run from the same file.
8774
8775@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
8776program's symbol table.
8777
5d161b24 8778The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
8779of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
8780auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
8781the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
8782the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
8783
8784@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
8785executing it once.
8786
8787When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
8788understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
8789generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
8790other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
8791Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
8792using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
8793optimized code.
c906108c
SS
8794
8795For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
8796using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
8797symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
8798quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
8799details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
8800
8801The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
8802start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
8803occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
8804file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
8805pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
8806warnings and messages}.)
8807
c906108c
SS
8808We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
8809symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
8810symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
8811still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
8812in stabs format.
8813
8814@kindex readnow
8815@cindex reading symbols immediately
8816@cindex symbols, reading immediately
8817@kindex mapped
8818@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
8819@cindex saving symbol table
8820@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8821@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8822You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
8823tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
8824load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 8825entire symbol table available.
c906108c 8826
c906108c
SS
8827If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
8828@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
8829cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
8830file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
8831from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
8832than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
8833program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
8834starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
8835
8836You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8837file has all the symbol information for your program.
8838
8839The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8840@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8841than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8842it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8843needed.
8844
8845The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8846@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8847symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
8848
8849@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8850@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8851@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8852@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8853@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8854@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8855@c files.
8856
8857@kindex core
8858@kindex core-file
8859@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8860Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8861of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8862address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8863executable file itself for other parts.
8864
8865@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8866to be used.
8867
8868Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
8869under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8870wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8871the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 8872(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 8873
c906108c
SS
8874@kindex add-symbol-file
8875@cindex dynamic linking
8876@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8877@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 8878@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
8879The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8880information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8881when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8882into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8883address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
8884this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8885of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8886section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8887@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
8888
8889The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8890originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
8891@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8892thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8893instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 8894
17d9d558
JB
8895@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
8896@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
8897@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
8898@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
8899@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
8900Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
8901executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
8902relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
8903information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
8904
8905@itemize @bullet
8906@item
8907the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
8908that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
8909@item
8910every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
8911been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
8912@item
8913you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
8914provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8915@end itemize
8916
8917@noindent
8918Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
8919relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
8920typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
8921important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
8922procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
8923assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
8924general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
8925relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
8926as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
8927way.
8928
c906108c
SS
8929@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8930
8931You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8932the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8933table information for @var{filename}.
8934
8935@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8936@item add-shared-symbol-file
8937The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
8938operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8939shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 8940@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 8941
c906108c
SS
8942@kindex section
8943@item section
5d161b24
DB
8944The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8945the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8946section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8947specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
8948separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8949the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
8950
8951@kindex info files
8952@kindex info target
8953@item info files
8954@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
8955@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8956current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8957including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8958use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8959command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8960current ones.
8961
c906108c
SS
8962@end table
8963
8964All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8965as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8966name and remembers it that way.
8967
c906108c 8968@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
8969@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8970libraries.
53a5351d 8971
c906108c
SS
8972@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8973when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8974(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8975references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8976debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
8977
8978On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8979automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8980
c906108c
SS
8981@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8982@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8983@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8984
b7209cb4
FF
8985There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
8986symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
8987particularly large or there are many of them.
8988
8989To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
8990commands:
8991
8992@table @code
8993@kindex set auto-solib-add
8994@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
8995If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
8996will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
8997attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
8998informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
8999is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9000@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9001
9002@kindex show auto-solib-add
9003@item show auto-solib-add
9004Display the current autoloading mode.
9005@end table
9006
9007To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9008command:
9009
c906108c
SS
9010@table @code
9011@kindex info sharedlibrary
9012@kindex info share
9013@item info share
9014@itemx info sharedlibrary
9015Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9016
9017@kindex sharedlibrary
9018@kindex share
9019@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9020@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9021Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9022Unix regular expression.
9023As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9024required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9025@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9026loaded.
9027@end table
9028
b7209cb4
FF
9029On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9030autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9031reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9032by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9033up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9034wish.
c906108c
SS
9035
9036Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9037loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9038@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9039automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9040
9041To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9042
9043@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9044@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9045@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9046Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9047If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9048symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9049size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9050Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
b7209cb4
FF
9051@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e. 100
9052Mb).
c906108c 9053
b7209cb4
FF
9054@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9055@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9056Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9057@end table
c906108c 9058
6d2ebf8b 9059@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9060@section Errors reading symbol files
9061
9062While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9063such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9064output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9065they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9066debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9067about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9068only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9069times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9070to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9071complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9072messages}).
9073
9074The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9075
9076@table @code
9077@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9078
9079The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9080(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9081error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9082in its outer scope blocks.
9083
9084@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9085the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9086may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9087function.
9088
9089@item block at @var{address} out of order
9090
9091The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9092order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9093do so.
9094
9095@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9096locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9097can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9098@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9099messages}.)
9100
9101@item bad block start address patched
9102
9103The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9104smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9105to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9106
9107@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9108starting on the previous source line.
9109
9110@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9111
9112@cindex foo
9113Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9114larger than the size of the string table.
9115
9116@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9117name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9118with this name.
9119
9120@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9121
7a292a7a
SS
9122The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9123not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9124uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9125
7a292a7a
SS
9126@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9127This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9128are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9129debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9130on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9131and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9132
9133@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9134
7a292a7a 9135@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9136
7a292a7a 9137@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9138The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9139information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9140it.
c906108c
SS
9141
9142@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9143
9144@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9145
c906108c
SS
9146@end table
9147
6d2ebf8b 9148@node Targets
c906108c 9149@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9150
c906108c
SS
9151@cindex debugging target
9152@kindex target
9153
9154A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9155
9156Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9157in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9158you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9159flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9160host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9161realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9162command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9163(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9164
9165@menu
9166* Active Targets:: Active targets
9167* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9168* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9169* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9170* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9171
9172@end menu
9173
6d2ebf8b 9174@node Active Targets
c906108c 9175@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9176
c906108c
SS
9177@cindex stacking targets
9178@cindex active targets
9179@cindex multiple targets
9180
c906108c 9181There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9182executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9183active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9184start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9185a core file.
c906108c
SS
9186
9187For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9188@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9189well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9190@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9191first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9192requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9193are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9194read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9195executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9196
9197When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9198target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9199commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9200an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9201process target is active.
c906108c 9202
7a292a7a
SS
9203Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9204core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9205files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9206the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9207process}).
c906108c 9208
6d2ebf8b 9209@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9210@section Commands for managing targets
9211
9212@table @code
9213@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9214Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9215process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9216facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9217protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9218
9219Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9220typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9221with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9222
9223The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9224after executing the command.
9225
9226@kindex help target
9227@item help target
9228Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9229currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9230(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9231
9232@item help target @var{name}
9233Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9234select it.
9235
9236@kindex set gnutarget
9237@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9238@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9239knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9240a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9241with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9242with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9243
d4f3574e 9244@quotation
c906108c
SS
9245@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9246you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9247@end quotation
c906108c 9248
d4f3574e
SS
9249@noindent
9250@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9251
5d161b24 9252@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9253@item show gnutarget
9254Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9255@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9256@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9257and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9258@end table
9259
c906108c
SS
9260Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9261configuration):
c906108c
SS
9262
9263@table @code
9264@kindex target exec
9265@item target exec @var{program}
9266An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9267@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9268
c906108c
SS
9269@kindex target core
9270@item target core @var{filename}
9271A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9272@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9273
9274@kindex target remote
9275@item target remote @var{dev}
9276Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9277specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9278@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9279supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9280some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9281it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9282
c906108c
SS
9283@kindex target sim
9284@item target sim
2df3850c 9285Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
9286In general,
9287@example
9288 target sim
9289 load
9290 run
9291@end example
d4f3574e 9292@noindent
104c1213 9293works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9294drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9295provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9296see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9297Processors}.
9298
c906108c
SS
9299@end table
9300
104c1213 9301Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9302
9303@table @code
9304
c906108c
SS
9305@kindex target nrom
9306@item target nrom @var{dev}
9307NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9308
c906108c
SS
9309@end table
9310
5d161b24 9311Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9312your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9313
9314Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9315once you've successfully established a connection.
9316
9317@table @code
9318
9319@kindex load @var{filename}
9320@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9321Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9322@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9323is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9324on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9325@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9326the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9327
9328If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9329execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9330target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9331
9332The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9333For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9334link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9335specifies a fixed address.
9336@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9337
c906108c
SS
9338@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9339@end table
9340
6d2ebf8b 9341@node Byte Order
c906108c 9342@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 9343
c906108c
SS
9344@cindex choosing target byte order
9345@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
9346
9347Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9348offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9349orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9350designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9351which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 9352@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
9353
9354@table @code
9355@kindex set endian big
9356@item set endian big
9357Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9358
9359@kindex set endian little
9360@item set endian little
9361Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9362
9363@kindex set endian auto
9364@item set endian auto
9365Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9366executable.
9367
9368@item show endian
9369Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9370
9371@end table
9372
9373Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9374data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9375target system.
9376
6d2ebf8b 9377@node Remote
c906108c
SS
9378@section Remote debugging
9379@cindex remote debugging
9380
9381If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
9382@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9383For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
9384or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9385powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9386
9387Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9388to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 9389@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
9390but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9391write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9392communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9393
9394Other remote targets may be available in your
9395configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 9396
c906108c 9397@menu
c906108c 9398* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
9399@end menu
9400
6d2ebf8b 9401@node Remote Serial
104c1213 9402@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 9403
104c1213
JM
9404@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
9405To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
9406@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
9407prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
9408program, you need:
c906108c 9409
104c1213
JM
9410@enumerate
9411@item
9412A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
9413have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
9414your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 9415
5d161b24 9416@item
d4f3574e 9417A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 9418subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 9419
104c1213
JM
9420@item
9421A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
9422download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
9423manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
9424documentation.
9425@end enumerate
96baa820 9426
104c1213
JM
9427The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
9428communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
9429machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 9430
104c1213
JM
9431@table @emph
9432@item On the host,
9433@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
9434else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
9435(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
9436
9437@item On the target,
9438you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
9439implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
9440subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
9441
9442On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
9443@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
9444@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
9445@end table
96baa820 9446
104c1213
JM
9447The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
9448machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
9449@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 9450
104c1213
JM
9451@cindex remote serial stub list
9452These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 9453
104c1213
JM
9454@table @code
9455
9456@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 9457@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9458@cindex Intel
9459@cindex i386
9460For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
9461
9462@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 9463@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9464@cindex Motorola 680x0
9465@cindex m680x0
9466For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
9467
9468@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 9469@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9470@cindex Hitachi
9471@cindex SH
9472For Hitachi SH architectures.
9473
9474@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 9475@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9476@cindex Sparc
9477For @sc{sparc} architectures.
9478
9479@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 9480@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9481@cindex Fujitsu
9482@cindex SparcLite
9483For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
9484
9485@end table
9486
9487The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
9488recently added stubs.
9489
9490@menu
9491* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
9492* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
9493* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
9494* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
9495* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
9496* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
9497@end menu
9498
6d2ebf8b 9499@node Stub Contents
104c1213
JM
9500@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
9501
9502@cindex remote serial stub
9503The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
9504subroutines:
9505
9506@table @code
9507@item set_debug_traps
9508@kindex set_debug_traps
9509@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
9510This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
9511program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
9512beginning of your program.
9513
9514@item handle_exception
9515@kindex handle_exception
9516@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
9517This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
9518explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
9519run when a trap is triggered.
9520
9521@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
9522execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
9523with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
9524protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 9525representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
9526information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
9527retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
9528execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
9529@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 9530machine.
104c1213
JM
9531
9532@item breakpoint
9533@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
9534Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
9535breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
9536way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
9537machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
9538pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
9539@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
9540simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
9541again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
9542your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 9543@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
9544
9545Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
9546to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
9547start of your debugging session.
9548@end table
9549
6d2ebf8b 9550@node Bootstrapping
104c1213
JM
9551@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
9552
9553@cindex remote stub, support routines
9554The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
9555chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
9556debugging target machine.
9557
9558First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
9559serial port.
9560
9561@table @code
9562@item int getDebugChar()
9563@kindex getDebugChar
9564Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
9565It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
9566different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9567
9568@item void putDebugChar(int)
9569@kindex putDebugChar
9570Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 9571It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
9572different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9573@end table
9574
9575@cindex control C, and remote debugging
9576@cindex interrupting remote targets
9577If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
9578running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
9579for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
9580character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
9581remote system to stop.
9582
9583Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
9584probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
9585is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
9586@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
9587
9588Other routines you need to supply are:
9589
9590@table @code
9591@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
9592@kindex exceptionHandler
9593Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
9594handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
9595way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
9596are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
9597containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
9598@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
9599its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
9600might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
9601exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
9602@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
9603and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
9604you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
9605should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
9606
9607For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
9608gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
9609should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
9610@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
9611help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
9612
9613@item void flush_i_cache()
9614@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 9615On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
9616instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
9617instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
9618
9619On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
9620function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
9621@end table
9622
9623@noindent
9624You must also make sure this library routine is available:
9625
9626@table @code
9627@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
9628@kindex memset
9629This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
9630memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
9631@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
9632either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
9633@end table
9634
9635If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
9636library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
9637but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 9638subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
9639
9640
6d2ebf8b 9641@node Debug Session
104c1213
JM
9642@subsubsection Putting it all together
9643
9644@cindex remote serial debugging summary
9645In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
9646steps.
9647
9648@enumerate
9649@item
6d2ebf8b 9650Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
9651(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
9652@display
9653@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
9654@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
9655@end display
9656
9657@item
9658Insert these lines near the top of your program:
9659
9660@example
9661set_debug_traps();
9662breakpoint();
9663@end example
9664
9665@item
9666For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
9667@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
9668
9669@example
9670void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
9671@end example
9672
d4f3574e 9673@noindent
104c1213 9674but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 9675function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
9676@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
9677error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
9678one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
9679
9680@item
9681Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
9682your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
9683
9684@item
9685Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
9686the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
9687
9688@item
9689@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
9690@c document that. FIXME.
9691Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
9692whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
9693
9694@item
9695To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
9696as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
9697This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
9698of its pure text.
9699
d4f3574e 9700@item
104c1213 9701@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9702Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
9703Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
9704machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9705TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
9706to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
9707device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
9708
9709@example
9710target remote /dev/ttyb
9711@end example
9712
9713@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
9714To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9715@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
9716terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
9717
9718@example
9719target remote manyfarms:2828
9720@end example
a2bea4c3
CV
9721
9722If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
9723your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
9724the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
9725to port 1234 on your local machine:
9726
9727@example
9728target remote :1234
9729@end example
9730@noindent
9731
9732Note that the colon is still required here.
104c1213
JM
9733@end enumerate
9734
9735Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
9736step and continue the remote program.
9737
9738To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
9739command.
9740
9741@cindex interrupting remote programs
9742@cindex remote programs, interrupting
9743Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
9744interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
9745program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
9746and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
9747interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
9748
9749@example
9750Interrupted while waiting for the program.
9751Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
9752@end example
9753
9754If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
9755(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
9756remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
9757goes back to waiting.
9758
6d2ebf8b 9759@node Protocol
104c1213
JM
9760@subsubsection Communication protocol
9761
9762@cindex debugging stub, example
9763@cindex remote stub, example
9764@cindex stub example, remote debugging
9765The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
9766communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
9767@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
9768these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
9769implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
9770with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
9771organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
9772
9773However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
9774the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
9775target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
9776it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
9777
9778In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
9779transmitted and received data respectfully.
9780
9781@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
9782@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
9783@cindex remote serial protocol
6cf7e474
AC
9784All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
9785sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
9786@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
9787@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
104c1213
JM
9788
9789@example
9790@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9791@end example
9792@noindent
104c1213
JM
9793
9794@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
9795@noindent
9796The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
6cf7e474
AC
9797characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
9798eight bit unsigned checksum).
9799
9800Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
9801specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
9802
9803@example
9804@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9805@end example
104c1213
JM
9806
9807@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
9808@noindent
6cf7e474
AC
9809That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
9810has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
9811since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
104c1213 9812
6cf7e474 9813@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
104c1213
JM
9814When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
9815response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
9816the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
9817retransmission):
9818
9819@example
9820<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9821-> @code{+}
9822@end example
9823@noindent
104c1213
JM
9824
9825The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
9826debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
9827the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
9828when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
9829
9830@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
6cf7e474
AC
9831exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
9832exceptions).
9833
9834Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
9835@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
9836HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
9837
9838Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
9839@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
9840would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
104c1213
JM
9841
9842Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 9843means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
9844which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
9845@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
9846where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
9847characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
9848value greater than 126 should not be used.
9849
9850Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
9851loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
9852character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
9853
9854So:
9855@example
9856"@code{0* }"
9857@end example
9858@noindent
9859means the same as "0000".
9860
598ca718 9861The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
104c1213
JM
9862error number. That number is not well defined.
9863
9864For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
9865(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
9866protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 9867on that response.
104c1213 9868
f1251bdd
C
9869A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
9870@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
9871optional.
9872
104c1213
JM
9873Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
9874their corresponding response @var{data}:
598ca718 9875@page
104c1213
JM
9876@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
9877@item Packet
9878@tab Request
9879@tab Description
9880
df2396a1 9881@item extended mode
104c1213
JM
9882@tab @code{!}
9883@tab
df2396a1 9884Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
656db9b0 9885persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
df2396a1 9886debugged.
104c1213 9887@item
df2396a1 9888@tab reply @samp{OK}
104c1213 9889@tab
df2396a1 9890The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
104c1213
JM
9891
9892@item last signal
9893@tab @code{?}
9894@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9895Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
9896and continue.
9897@item
9898@tab reply
9899@tab see below
9900
104c1213
JM
9901
9902@item reserved
9903@tab @code{a}
5d161b24 9904@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9905
f1251bdd 9906@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9907@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
9908@tab
598ca718
EZ
9909@item
9910@tab
9911@tab
104c1213
JM
9912Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9913specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 9914See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
9915@item
9916@tab reply @code{OK}
9917@item
9918@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9919
9920@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9921@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9922@tab
9923Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9924transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9925transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9926acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9927to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9928ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9929specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9930that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9931happened.}
9932
9933@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9934@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9935@tab
9936Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9937breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9938@samp{z} packets.}
9939
9940@item continue
9941@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9942@tab
9943@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9944current address.
9945@item
9946@tab reply
9947@tab see below
9948
f1251bdd 9949@item continue with signal
104c1213
JM
9950@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9951@tab
9952Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9953@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9954@item
9955@tab reply
9956@tab see below
9957
598ca718 9958@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
9959@tab @code{d}
9960@tab
d4f3574e 9961toggle debug flag.
104c1213 9962
f1251bdd 9963@item detach
104c1213 9964@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 9965@tab
2df3850c
JM
9966Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9967@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
9968@item
9969@tab reply @emph{no response}
9970@tab
598ca718 9971@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
104c1213
JM
9972
9973@item reserved
9974@tab @code{e}
5d161b24 9975@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9976
9977@item reserved
9978@tab @code{E}
5d161b24 9979@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9980
9981@item reserved
9982@tab @code{f}
5d161b24 9983@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9984
9985@item reserved
9986@tab @code{F}
5d161b24 9987@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9988
9989@item read registers
9990@tab @code{g}
9991@tab Read general registers.
9992@item
9993@tab reply @var{XX...}
9994@tab
9995Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9996with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 9997each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 9998determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
9999@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
10000@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
10001@item
10002@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
10003@tab for an error.
10004
10005@item write regs
10006@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
10007@tab
10008See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
10009@item
10010@tab reply @code{OK}
10011@tab for success
10012@item
10013@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10014@tab for an error
10015
10016@item reserved
10017@tab @code{h}
5d161b24 10018@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10019
f1251bdd 10020@item set thread
104c1213
JM
10021@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
10022@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10023Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
10024@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
10025continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
10026thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
10027@item
10028@tab reply @code{OK}
10029@tab for success
10030@item
10031@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10032@tab for an error
10033
d4f3574e
SS
10034@c FIXME: JTC:
10035@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
5d161b24 10036@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
d4f3574e
SS
10037@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
10038@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
10039@c described. For example:
10040@c
10041@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
10042@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
10043@c otherwise returns current registers.
10044@c
10045@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
10046@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
10047@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
10048
f1251bdd 10049@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10050@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
10051@tab
10052Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
10053present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
10054step starting at that address.
10055
f1251bdd 10056@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
10057@tab @code{I}
10058@tab
10059See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
10060
10061@item reserved
10062@tab @code{j}
10063@tab Reserved for future use
10064
10065@item reserved
10066@tab @code{J}
5d161b24 10067@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10068
f1251bdd 10069@item kill request
104c1213
JM
10070@tab @code{k}
10071@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10072FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
10073thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
10074
10075@item reserved
10076@tab @code{l}
5d161b24 10077@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10078
10079@item reserved
10080@tab @code{L}
5d161b24 10081@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10082
10083@item read memory
10084@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10085@tab
10086Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 10087Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
10088using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
10089transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
10090@item
10091@tab reply @var{XX...}
10092@tab
d4f3574e 10093@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 10094to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
10095sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
10096@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
10097@item
10098@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10099@tab @var{NN} is errno
10100
10101@item write mem
10102@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
10103@tab
10104Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
10105@var{XX...} is the data.
10106@item
10107@tab reply @code{OK}
10108@tab for success
10109@item
10110@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10111@tab
10112for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
10113written).
10114
10115@item reserved
10116@tab @code{n}
5d161b24 10117@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10118
10119@item reserved
10120@tab @code{N}
5d161b24 10121@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10122
10123@item reserved
10124@tab @code{o}
5d161b24 10125@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10126
10127@item reserved
10128@tab @code{O}
5d161b24 10129@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10130
10131@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
10132@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
10133@tab
10134See write register.
10135@item
10136@tab return @var{r....}
10137@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
10138
f1251bdd 10139@item write reg
104c1213
JM
10140@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
10141@tab
10142Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
10143digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
10144@item
10145@tab reply @code{OK}
10146@tab for success
10147@item
10148@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10149@tab for an error
10150
f1251bdd 10151@item general query
104c1213
JM
10152@tab @code{q}@var{query}
10153@tab
598ca718 10154Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
104c1213 10155have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
10156company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
10157optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
10158must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
10159@item
10160@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 10161@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
10162@item
10163@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10164@tab error reply
10165@item
10166@tab reply @samp{}
10167@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
10168
f1251bdd 10169@item general set
104c1213
JM
10170@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
10171@tab
10172Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
10173naming conventions.
10174
598ca718 10175@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
d4f3574e
SS
10176@tab @code{r}
10177@tab
10178Reset the entire system.
104c1213 10179
f1251bdd 10180@item remote restart
104c1213
JM
10181@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
10182@tab
df2396a1
AC
10183Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
10184This packet is only available in extended mode.
10185@item
10186@tab
10187no reply
10188@tab
10189The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
104c1213 10190
f1251bdd 10191@item step
104c1213
JM
10192@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
10193@tab
10194@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
10195same address.
10196@item
10197@tab reply
10198@tab see below
10199
f1251bdd 10200@item step with signal
104c1213
JM
10201@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
10202@tab
10203Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
10204@item
10205@tab reply
10206@tab see below
10207
f1251bdd 10208@item search
104c1213
JM
10209@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
10210@tab
10211Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
10212@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 10213bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213 10214
f1251bdd 10215@item thread alive
104c1213
JM
10216@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
10217@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
10218@item
10219@tab reply @code{OK}
10220@tab thread is still alive
10221@item
10222@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10223@tab thread is dead
5d161b24 10224
104c1213
JM
10225@item reserved
10226@tab @code{u}
5d161b24 10227@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10228
10229@item reserved
10230@tab @code{U}
5d161b24 10231@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10232
10233@item reserved
10234@tab @code{v}
5d161b24 10235@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10236
10237@item reserved
10238@tab @code{V}
5d161b24 10239@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10240
10241@item reserved
10242@tab @code{w}
5d161b24 10243@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10244
10245@item reserved
10246@tab @code{W}
5d161b24 10247@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10248
10249@item reserved
10250@tab @code{x}
5d161b24 10251@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10252
f1251bdd 10253@item write mem (binary)
104c1213
JM
10254@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
10255@tab
10256@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
10257binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
10258escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
10259@item
10260@tab reply @code{OK}
10261@tab for success
10262@item
10263@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10264@tab for an error
10265
10266@item reserved
10267@tab @code{y}
5d161b24 10268@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10269
10270@item reserved
10271@tab @code{Y}
5d161b24 10272@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10273
f1251bdd 10274@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10275@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10276@tab
10277See @samp{Z}.
10278
f1251bdd 10279@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10280@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10281@tab
10282@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
10283breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
10284@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
10285bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
10286the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
10287@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
10288potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
6d2ebf8b 10289implemented in an idempotent way.
104c1213
JM
10290@item
10291@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10292@tab for an error
10293@item
10294@tab reply @code{OK}
10295@tab for success
10296@item
10297@tab @samp{}
10298@tab If not supported.
10299
10300@item reserved
10301@tab <other>
5d161b24 10302@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10303
10304@end multitable
10305
d4f3574e
SS
10306The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
10307receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
10308@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
10309when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
10310number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
10311conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
10312
10313@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
10314
10315@item @code{S}@var{AA}
10316@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
10317
10318@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
10319@tab
10320@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
10321(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
10322by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
10323thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 10324starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
10325@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
10326extend the protocol.
10327
10328@item @code{W}@var{AA}
10329@tab
10330The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
10331applicable for certains sorts of targets.
10332
10333@item @code{X}@var{AA}
10334@tab
10335The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
10336
6d2ebf8b 10337@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
104c1213 10338@tab
6d2ebf8b
SS
10339@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
10340@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
10341@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
10342this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
10343spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
10344debugger.}
104c1213
JM
10345
10346@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
10347@tab
c3f6f71d 10348@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
10349while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
10350for 'W', 'T', etc.
10351
10352@end multitable
10353
d4f3574e
SS
10354The following set and query packets have already been defined.
10355
10356@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
10357
10358@item current thread
10359@tab @code{q}@code{C}
10360@tab Return the current thread id.
10361@item
10362@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
10363@tab
10364Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
10365@item
10366@tab reply *
10367@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
10368
bba2971c
MS
10369@item all thread ids
10370@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10371@item
10372@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 10373@tab
bba2971c
MS
10374Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
10375may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
10376works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
10377obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
5d161b24 10378be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
bba2971c 10379sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 10380@item
bba2971c
MS
10381@tab
10382@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 10383@item
5d161b24 10384@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
bba2971c
MS
10385@tab A single thread id
10386@item
00e4a2e4 10387@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
bba2971c
MS
10388@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
10389@item
10390@tab reply @code{l}
10391@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
10392@item
10393@tab
10394@tab
10395In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
10396or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
10397respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
10398@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
10399(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
10400
10401@item extra thread info
480ff1fb 10402@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
bba2971c
MS
10403@tab
10404@item
10405@tab
10406@tab
10407Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
10408Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
10409the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
10410thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
10411The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
5d161b24 10412Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
bba2971c
MS
10413"Blocked on Mutex".
10414@item
10415@tab reply @var{XX...}
10416@tab
10417Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
10418printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
10419attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
10420
10421@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
10422@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
10423@tab
2b628194
MS
10424@item
10425@tab
10426@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10427Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
10428digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
10429subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
10430number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
10431(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
10432returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
10433@item
bba2971c
MS
10434@tab
10435@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10436query (see above).
10437@item
d4f3574e
SS
10438@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
10439@tab
2b628194
MS
10440@item
10441@tab
10442@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10443Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
10444returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
10445and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
10446digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
10447a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
10448digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
10449
bba2971c
MS
10450@item compute CRC of memory block
10451@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10452@tab
10453@item
10454@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10455@tab An error (such as memory fault)
10456@item
10457@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
10458@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
10459
d4f3574e
SS
10460@item query sect offs
10461@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
10462@tab
10463Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
10464image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
10465response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
10466offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
10467@item
10468@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
10469
10470@item thread info request
10471@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
10472@tab
598ca718
EZ
10473@item
10474@tab
10475@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10476Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
10477encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
10478@item
10479@tab reply *
10480@tab
10481See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
10482
10483@item remote command
10484@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
10485@tab
598ca718
EZ
10486@item
10487@tab
10488@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10489@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
10490execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
10491Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
10492number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
10493packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
10494stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
10495@item
10496@tab reply @code{OK}
10497@tab
10498A command response with no output.
10499@item
10500@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
10501@tab
10502A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
10503@item
10504@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10505@tab
10506Indicate a badly formed request.
10507
10508@item
10509@tab reply @samp{}
10510@tab
10511When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
10512
0f1f2b0a
MS
10513@item symbol lookup
10514@tab @code{qSymbol::}
10515@tab
10516Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
10517requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
10518@item
10519@tab
10520@tab
10521@item
10522@tab reply @code{OK}
10523@tab
10524The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10525@item
10526@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10527@tab
10528The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10529@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
10530@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10531message, described below.
10532
10533@item symbol value
10534@tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10535@tab
10536Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
10537@item
10538@tab
10539@tab
10540@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
10541the target has previously requested.
10542@item
10543@tab
10544@tab
10545@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
10546If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
10547field will be empty.
10548@item
10549@tab reply @code{OK}
10550@tab
10551The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10552@item
10553@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10554@tab
10555The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10556@value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
10557until the target ceases to request them.
10558
d4f3574e
SS
10559@end multitable
10560
10561The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
10562In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
10563bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
10564space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
10565The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
10566least-significant.
10567
10568@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
10569
10570@item MIPS32
10571@tab
10572All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1057332 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
10574registers; fsr; fir; fp.
10575
10576@item MIPS64
10577@tab
10578All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
10579thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
10580as @code{MIPS32}.
10581
10582@end multitable
10583
104c1213
JM
10584Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
10585does not get any direct output:
10586
10587@example
10588<- @code{R00}
10589-> @code{+}
10590@emph{target restarts}
10591<- @code{?}
10592-> @code{+}
10593-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10594<- @code{+}
10595@end example
10596
10597Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
10598
10599@example
10600<- @code{G1445...}
10601-> @code{+}
10602<- @code{s}
10603-> @code{+}
10604@emph{time passes}
10605-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10606<- @code{+}
10607<- @code{g}
10608-> @code{+}
10609-> @code{1455...}
10610<- @code{+}
10611@end example
10612
6d2ebf8b 10613@node Server
104c1213
JM
10614@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10615
10616@kindex gdbserver
10617@cindex remote connection without stubs
10618@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10619allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10620@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10621
10622@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10623because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10624that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10625@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10626@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10627because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10628also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10629started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10630Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10631the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10632do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10633by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10634choice for debugging.
10635
10636@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10637or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10638protocol.
10639
10640@table @emph
10641@item On the target machine,
10642you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10643@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10644strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10645system does all the symbol handling.
10646
10647To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10648the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
10649syntax is:
10650
10651@smallexample
10652target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10653@end smallexample
10654
10655@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10656hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10657@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10658@file{/dev/com1}:
10659
10660@smallexample
10661target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10662@end smallexample
10663
10664@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10665with it.
10666
10667To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10668
10669@smallexample
10670target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10671@end smallexample
10672
10673The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10674specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10675TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10676expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10677(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10678you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10679TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10680reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10681conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 10682and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
10683@code{target remote} command.
10684
10685@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10686you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10687symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10688using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10689(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10690running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10691remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10692is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10693@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10694@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10695
10696@smallexample
10697(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10698@end smallexample
10699
10700@noindent
10701communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10702
10703@smallexample
10704(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10705@end smallexample
10706
10707@noindent
10708communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10709For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10710the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10711text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10712@samp{Connection refused}.
10713@end table
10714
6d2ebf8b 10715@node NetWare
104c1213
JM
10716@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10717
10718@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10719@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10720allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10721@code{target remote}.
10722
10723@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10724using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10725
10726@table @emph
10727@item On the target machine,
10728you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10729@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10730can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10731host system does all the symbol handling.
10732
10733To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10734@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10735program. The syntax is:
10736
5d161b24 10737@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10738load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10739 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10740@end smallexample
10741
10742@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10743the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 10744to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
10745
10746For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
5d161b24 10747communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 10748using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
10749
10750@smallexample
10751load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10752@end smallexample
10753
10754@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10755you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10756symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10757using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10758(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10759running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10760remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10761argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10762@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10763
10764@smallexample
10765(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10766@end smallexample
10767
10768@noindent
10769communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10770@end table
10771
6d2ebf8b 10772@node KOD
104c1213
JM
10773@section Kernel Object Display
10774
10775@cindex kernel object display
10776@cindex kernel object
10777@cindex KOD
10778
10779Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10780@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10781and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10782mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10783displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10784
10785Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10786@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10787
10788@example
2df3850c 10789(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
10790@end example
10791
10792If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10793about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10794which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10795after the operating system:
10796
10797@example
2df3850c 10798(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
10799List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10800Object Description
10801any Any and all objects
10802@end example
10803
10804Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10805by the kernel.
10806
10807There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
10808is supported other than to try it.
10809
10810
6d2ebf8b 10811@node Configurations
104c1213
JM
10812@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10813
10814While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10815cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10816describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10817
10818There are three major categories of configurations: native
10819configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10820operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10821different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10822are quite different from each other.
10823
10824@menu
10825* Native::
10826* Embedded OS::
10827* Embedded Processors::
10828* Architectures::
10829@end menu
10830
6d2ebf8b 10831@node Native
104c1213
JM
10832@section Native
10833
10834This section describes details specific to particular native
10835configurations.
10836
10837@menu
10838* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10839* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9f20bf26 10840* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
104c1213
JM
10841@end menu
10842
6d2ebf8b 10843@node HP-UX
104c1213
JM
10844@subsection HP-UX
10845
10846On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10847begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10848name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10849
6d2ebf8b 10850@node SVR4 Process Information
104c1213
JM
10851@subsection SVR4 process information
10852
10853@kindex /proc
10854@cindex process image
10855
10856Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10857used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10858subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10859this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10860several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10861@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10862@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10863and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10864
10865@table @code
10866@kindex info proc
10867@item info proc
10868Summarize available information about the process.
10869
10870@kindex info proc mappings
10871@item info proc mappings
10872Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10873on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10874
10875@kindex info proc times
10876@item info proc times
10877Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10878its children.
10879
10880@kindex info proc id
10881@item info proc id
10882Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10883the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10884
10885@kindex info proc status
10886@item info proc status
10887General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10888stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10889received.
10890
10891@item info proc all
10892Show all the above information about the process.
10893@end table
10894
9f20bf26
EZ
10895@node DJGPP Native
10896@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10897@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10898@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10899@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
10900
10901@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10902MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10903that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10904top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
10905
10906@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10907defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10908subsection describes those commands.
10909
10910@table @code
10911@kindex info dos
10912@item info dos
10913This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10914information about the target system and important OS structures.
10915
10916@kindex sysinfo
10917@cindex MS-DOS system info
10918@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10919@item info dos sysinfo
10920This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10921platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10922DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
10923
10924@cindex GDT
10925@cindex LDT
10926@cindex IDT
10927@cindex segment descriptor tables
10928@cindex descriptor tables display
10929@item info dos gdt
10930@itemx info dos ldt
10931@itemx info dos idt
10932These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10933and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10934tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10935that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10936descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10937descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10938rights.
10939
10940A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10941segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10942allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10943conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10944additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
10945
10946@cindex garbled pointers
10947These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10948Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10949displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10950display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10951example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10952debugged program's data segment:
10953
10954@smallexample
10955(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds
109560x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)
10957@end smallexample
10958
10959@noindent
10960This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10961the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
10962
10963@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10964@item info dos pde
10965@itemx info dos pte
10966These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10967Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10968data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10969into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10970page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10971may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10972Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10973that is currently in use.
10974
10975Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10976Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10977the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10978@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10979Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10980means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10981the specified entry in the Page Directory.
10982
10983These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10984Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10985controller.
10986
10987These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
10988
10989@cindex physical address from linear address
10990@item info dos address-pte
10991This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10992address. The argument linear address should already have the
10993appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10994accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10995example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
10996the variable @code{i} is stored:
10997
10998@smallexample
10999(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i
11000Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:
11001Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30
11002@end smallexample
11003
11004@noindent
11005This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11006whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11007attributes of that page.
11008
11009Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11010since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11011address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11012be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11013declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11014@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
11015
11016Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11017transfer buffer:
11018
11019@smallexample
11020(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)
11021Page Table entry for address 0x29110:
11022Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110
11023@end smallexample
11024
11025@noindent
11026(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
110273rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11028this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11029mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
11030
11031This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11032@end table
11033
6d2ebf8b 11034@node Embedded OS
104c1213
JM
11035@section Embedded Operating Systems
11036
11037This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11038embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11039architectures.
11040
11041@menu
11042* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11043@end menu
11044
11045@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11046various real-time operating systems.
11047
6d2ebf8b 11048@node VxWorks
104c1213
JM
11049@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11050
11051@cindex VxWorks
11052
11053@table @code
11054
11055@kindex target vxworks
11056@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11057A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11058is the target system's machine name or IP address.
11059
11060@end table
11061
11062On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11063current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
11064
11065@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11066VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11067the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11068both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 11069@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 11070installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 11071@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
11072
11073@table @code
11074@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11075@kindex vxworks-timeout
5d161b24
DB
11076All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11077This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11078seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11079your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
104c1213
JM
11080of a thin network line.
11081@end table
11082
11083The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11084this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11085procedures.
11086
11087@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11088To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11089to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11090library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11091VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11092kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11093source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11094information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11095manual.
11096@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
11097
11098Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11099your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
11100run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11101@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
11102
11103@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11104
11105@example
11106(vxgdb)
11107@end example
11108
11109@menu
11110* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11111* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11112* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11113@end menu
11114
6d2ebf8b 11115@node VxWorks Connection
104c1213
JM
11116@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
11117
11118The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11119network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
11120
11121@example
11122(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
11123@end example
11124
11125@need 750
11126@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11127
11128@smallexample
5d161b24 11129Attaching remote machine across net...
104c1213
JM
11130Connected to tt.
11131@end smallexample
11132
11133@need 1000
11134@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11135loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11136these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11137path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11138to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
11139
11140@example
11141prog.o: No such file or directory.
11142@end example
11143
11144When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11145the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11146command again.
11147
6d2ebf8b 11148@node VxWorks Download
104c1213
JM
11149@subsubsection VxWorks download
11150
11151@cindex download to VxWorks
11152If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11153object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11154@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11155incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11156command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11157to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11158table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11159the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11160filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11161Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11162to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11163the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11164@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11165and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11166program, type this on VxWorks:
11167
11168@example
11169-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
11170@end example
d4f3574e
SS
11171
11172@noindent
104c1213
JM
11173Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11174
11175@example
5d161b24 11176(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
104c1213
JM
11177(vxgdb) load prog.o
11178@end example
11179
11180@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
11181
11182@smallexample
11183Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11184@end smallexample
11185
11186You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11187after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11188this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11189auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11190history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 11191debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
11192table.)
11193
6d2ebf8b 11194@node VxWorks Attach
104c1213
JM
11195@subsubsection Running tasks
11196
11197@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11198You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11199follows:
11200
11201@example
11202(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
11203@end example
11204
11205@noindent
11206where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11207or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11208the time of attachment.
11209
6d2ebf8b 11210@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11211@section Embedded Processors
11212
11213This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11214configurations.
11215
11216@menu
11217* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
11218* ARM:: ARM
11219* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11220* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11221* i960:: Intel i960
11222* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11223* M68K:: Motorola M68K
11224* M88K:: Motorola M88K
11225* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11226* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11227* PowerPC: PowerPC
11228* SH:: Hitachi SH
11229* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11230* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11231* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11232* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11233@end menu
11234
6d2ebf8b 11235@node A29K Embedded
104c1213
JM
11236@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
11237
11238@menu
11239* A29K UDI::
11240* A29K EB29K::
11241* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
11242* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
11243* Remote Log:: Remote log
11244@end menu
11245
11246@table @code
11247
11248@kindex target adapt
11249@item target adapt @var{dev}
11250Adapt monitor for A29K.
11251
11252@kindex target amd-eb
11253@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
11254@cindex AMD EB29K
11255Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
11256@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
11257@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
11258name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
11259@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
11260
11261@end table
11262
6d2ebf8b 11263@node A29K UDI
104c1213
JM
11264@subsubsection A29K UDI
11265
11266@cindex UDI
11267@cindex AMD29K via UDI
11268
11269@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
11270protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
11271configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
11272program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
11273use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
11274@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
11275
11276@table @code
11277@item target udi @var{keyword}
11278@kindex udi
11279Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
11280@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
11281This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
11282connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
11283working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
11284to its pathname.
11285@end table
11286
6d2ebf8b 11287@node A29K EB29K
104c1213
JM
11288@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
11289
11290@cindex EB29K board
11291@cindex running 29K programs
11292
11293AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
11294with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
11295term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
11296@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
11297must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
11298board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
11299assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
11300@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
11301
6d2ebf8b 11302@node Comms (EB29K)
104c1213
JM
11303@subsubsection Communications setup
11304
11305The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
11306in DOS on the PC:
11307
11308@example
11309C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
11310@end example
11311
11312@noindent
11313This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
11314bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
11315you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
11316end of the connection as well.
11317@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
5d161b24 11318@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11319@c
11320@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
11321@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
11322@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
11323@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
11324@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
11325
11326To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
11327the following at the DOS console:
11328
11329@example
11330C:\> CTTY com1
11331@end example
11332
11333@noindent
11334(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
11335the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 11336had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
11337
11338From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
11339@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
11340
11341@example
11342cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
11343@end example
11344
11345@noindent
11346The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
11347serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
11348may look something like the following:
11349
11350@example
11351tip -9600 /dev/ttya
11352@end example
11353
11354@noindent
11355Your system may require a different name where we show
11356@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
11357parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
11358@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
11359system table @file{/etc/remote}.
11360@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
11361@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
11362@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
11363@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
11364@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
11365@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
11366@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11367@c
11368@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11369@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11370@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
11371
11372@kindex EBMON
11373Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11374directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11375start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11376with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
11377@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11378@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11379
11380@example
11381C:\> G:
11382
11383G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11384
11385G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11386Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11387Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11388Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11389
11390Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11391
11392PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
11393I/O Base = 0x208
11394Memory Base = 0xd0000
11395
11396Data Memory Size = 2048KB
11397Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11398Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11399
11400PageSize = 0x400
11401Register Stack Size = 0x800
11402Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
11403
11404CPU PRL = 0x3
11405Am29027 Available = No
11406Byte Write Available = Yes
11407
11408# ~.
11409@end example
11410
11411Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11412typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
11413running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11414
11415For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11416way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 11417system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
11418PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
11419something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11420other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11421from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11422serial line.
11423
6d2ebf8b 11424@node gdb-EB29K
104c1213
JM
11425@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11426
11427Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11428program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11429name of your 29K program:
11430
11431@example
11432cd /usr/joe/work29k
11433@value{GDBP} myfoo
11434@end example
11435
11436@need 500
11437Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11438
11439@example
11440target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11441@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
11442@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11443@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11444@end example
11445
11446@noindent
11447In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11448@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11449@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11450In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11451a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11452the name on the Unix side.
11453
11454At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11455to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11456@code{run}.
11457
11458To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11459command.
11460
11461To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11462once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11463@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11464@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 11465Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
11466and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11467
6d2ebf8b 11468@node Remote Log
104c1213 11469@subsubsection Remote log
41afff9a 11470@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
104c1213
JM
11471@cindex log file for EB29K
11472
11473The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
11474current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
11475@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
11476of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
11477another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
11478unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
11479
6d2ebf8b 11480@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11481@subsection ARM
11482
11483@table @code
11484
11485@kindex target rdi
11486@item target rdi @var{dev}
11487ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11488use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11489monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
5d161b24 11490
104c1213
JM
11491@kindex target rdp
11492@item target rdp @var{dev}
11493ARM Demon monitor.
11494
11495@end table
11496
6d2ebf8b 11497@node H8/300
104c1213
JM
11498@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11499
11500@table @code
11501
d4f3574e 11502@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11503@item target hms @var{dev}
11504A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11505Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11506line and the communications speed used.
11507
d4f3574e 11508@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11509@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11510E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11511
d4f3574e
SS
11512@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11513@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 11514@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 11515@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
11516Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11517
11518@end table
11519
11520@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11521@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11522@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11523@cindex Hitachi SH download
11524When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11525board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11526board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11527@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11528
11529@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
5d161b24 11530Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
104c1213
JM
11531
11532@enumerate
11533@item
11534that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11535for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11536emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 11537the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
11538H8/300, or H8/500.)
11539
11540@item
11541what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11542serial device available on your host is the default).
11543
11544@item
11545what speed to use over the serial device.
11546@end enumerate
11547
11548@menu
11549* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11550* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11551* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11552@end menu
11553
6d2ebf8b 11554@node Hitachi Boards
104c1213
JM
11555@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11556
11557@c only for Unix hosts
11558@kindex device
11559@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11560Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
11561need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11562first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11563hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11564
11565@kindex speed
11566@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11567@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 11568speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 11569hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
11570the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11571@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
11572
11573The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11574use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11575use a DOS host,
11576@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11577called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11578through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11579to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11580
11581The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11582program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11583sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11584the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11585
11586First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11587board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11588port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11589When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 11590debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
11591for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11592@code{COM2}.
11593
11594@example
11595C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11596C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11597
11598Resident portion of MODE loaded
11599
11600COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11601
11602@end example
11603
11604@quotation
11605@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11606@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11607disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11608your development board.
11609@end quotation
11610
d4f3574e 11611@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
11612Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11613connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 11614the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
11615you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11616commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11617cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11618download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11619the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11620(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11621executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11622@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11623itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11624
11625@smallexample
11626(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 11627@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 11628 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
104c1213 11629 the conditions.
5d161b24 11630There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 11631for details.
2df3850c
JM
11632@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11633(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 11634Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 11635(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
11636.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11637.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11638.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11639@end smallexample
11640
11641At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11642you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11643sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11644@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11645resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11646@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11647
11648Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11649available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11650you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11651
11652Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11653@itemize @bullet
11654@item
11655to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11656no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11657
11658@item
11659to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11660normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11661to detect program completion.
11662@end itemize
11663
11664In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11665development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11666
6d2ebf8b 11667@node Hitachi ICE
104c1213
JM
11668@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11669
d4f3574e 11670@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
11671You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11672Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11673e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11674
11675@table @code
11676@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11677Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11678@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11679@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11680(for example, @samp{9600}).
11681
11682@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11683If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11684specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11685@end table
11686
6d2ebf8b 11687@node Hitachi Special
104c1213
JM
11688@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11689
11690Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11691
11692@table @code
11693
11694@kindex set machine
11695@kindex show machine
11696@item set machine h8300
11697@itemx set machine h8300h
11698Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11699architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11700to check which variant is currently in effect.
11701
11702@end table
11703
6d2ebf8b 11704@node H8/500
104c1213
JM
11705@subsection H8/500
11706
11707@table @code
11708
11709@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11710@cindex memory models, H8/500
11711@item set memory @var{mod}
11712@itemx show memory
11713Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11714@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11715memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11716@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11717
11718@end table
11719
6d2ebf8b 11720@node i960
104c1213
JM
11721@subsection Intel i960
11722
11723@table @code
11724
11725@kindex target mon960
11726@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11727MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11728
f0ca3dce 11729@kindex target nindy
104c1213
JM
11730@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11731An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11732the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11733@file{/dev/ttya}.
11734
11735@end table
11736
11737@cindex Nindy
11738@cindex i960
11739@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11740@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11741tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11742
11743@itemize @bullet
11744@item
11745Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11746Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11747
11748@item
11749By responding to a prompt on startup;
11750
11751@item
11752By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11753session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11754
104c1213
JM
11755@end itemize
11756
11757@cindex download to Nindy-960
11758With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11759downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11760@value{GDBN}.
11761
11762@menu
11763* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11764* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11765* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11766@end menu
11767
6d2ebf8b 11768@node Nindy Startup
104c1213
JM
11769@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11770
11771If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11772options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11773reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11774
11775@example
5d161b24 11776Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
104c1213
JM
11777@end example
11778
11779@noindent
11780Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11781identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11782simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11783with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11784use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11785
6d2ebf8b 11786@node Nindy Options
104c1213
JM
11787@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11788
11789These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11790Nindy-960 board attached:
11791
11792@table @code
11793@item -r @var{port}
11794Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11795to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11796configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11797@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11798device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11799suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11800
11801@item -O
11802(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11803the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11804This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11805target architecture.
11806
11807@quotation
11808@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11809connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11810fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11811attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11812this process with an interrupt.
11813@end quotation
11814
11815@item -brk
11816Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11817system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11818
11819@quotation
11820@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11821requires; it only works with a few boards.
11822@end quotation
11823@end table
11824
11825The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11826port.
11827
11828@c @group
6d2ebf8b 11829@node Nindy Reset
104c1213
JM
11830@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11831
11832@table @code
11833@item reset
11834@kindex reset
11835For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11836system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11837circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11838a break is detected.
11839@end table
11840@c @end group
11841
6d2ebf8b 11842@node M32R/D
104c1213
JM
11843@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11844
11845@table @code
11846
11847@kindex target m32r
11848@item target m32r @var{dev}
11849Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11850
11851@end table
11852
6d2ebf8b 11853@node M68K
104c1213
JM
11854@subsection M68k
11855
11856The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11857target command for the following ROM monitors.
11858
11859@table @code
11860
11861@kindex target abug
11862@item target abug @var{dev}
11863ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11864
11865@kindex target cpu32bug
11866@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11867CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11868
11869@kindex target dbug
11870@item target dbug @var{dev}
11871dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11872
11873@kindex target est
11874@item target est @var{dev}
11875EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11876
11877@kindex target rom68k
11878@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11879ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11880
11881@end table
11882
11883If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11884instead have only a single special target command:
11885
11886@table @code
11887
11888@kindex target es1800
11889@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11890ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11891
11892@end table
11893
11894[context?]
11895
11896@table @code
11897
11898@kindex target rombug
11899@item target rombug @var{dev}
11900ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11901
11902@end table
11903
6d2ebf8b 11904@node M88K
104c1213
JM
11905@subsection M88K
11906
11907@table @code
11908
11909@kindex target bug
11910@item target bug @var{dev}
11911BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11912
11913@end table
11914
6d2ebf8b 11915@node MIPS Embedded
104c1213
JM
11916@subsection MIPS Embedded
11917
11918@cindex MIPS boards
11919@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11920MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11921you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11922
11923@need 1000
11924Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11925
11926@table @code
11927@item target mips @var{port}
11928@kindex target mips @var{port}
11929To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11930name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11931command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11932the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11933been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11934download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11935
11936For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11937port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11938debugger:
11939
11940@example
11941host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
11942@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11943(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11944(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11945(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
11946@end example
11947
11948@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11949On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11950connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11951concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11952@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11953
11954@item target pmon @var{port}
11955@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11956PMON ROM monitor.
11957
11958@item target ddb @var{port}
11959@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11960NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11961
11962@item target lsi @var{port}
11963@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11964LSI variant of PMON.
11965
11966@kindex target r3900
11967@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11968Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11969
11970@kindex target array
11971@item target array @var{dev}
11972Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11973
11974@end table
11975
11976
11977@noindent
11978@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11979
11980@table @code
11981@item set processor @var{args}
11982@itemx show processor
11983@kindex set processor @var{args}
11984@kindex show processor
11985Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11986processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
5d161b24 11987For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
96c405b3 11988to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
5d161b24 11989Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
104c1213 11990is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
5d161b24 11991@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213
JM
11992
11993@item set mipsfpu double
11994@itemx set mipsfpu single
11995@itemx set mipsfpu none
11996@itemx show mipsfpu
11997@kindex set mipsfpu
11998@kindex show mipsfpu
11999@cindex MIPS remote floating point
12000@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
12001If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
12002coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 12003need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
12004file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
12005functions which return floating point values. It also allows
12006@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
12007functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
12008with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
12009processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
12010double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
12011@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
12012
12013In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
12014floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
12015and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
12016
12017As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
12018@samp{show mipsfpu}.
12019
12020@item set remotedebug @var{n}
12021@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
12022@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12023@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
12024@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
12025@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
12026@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
12027@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
12028You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
12029by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
12030@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
12031to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
12032at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
12033
12034@item set timeout @var{seconds}
12035@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
12036@itemx show timeout
12037@itemx show retransmit-timeout
12038@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
12039@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
12040@kindex set timeout
12041@kindex show timeout
12042@kindex set retransmit-timeout
12043@kindex show retransmit-timeout
12044You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
12045remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
12046default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
12047waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
12048retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
12049You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
12050retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
12051@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
12052
12053The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
12054is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12055forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12056to run before stopping.
12057@end table
12058
6d2ebf8b 12059@node PowerPC
104c1213
JM
12060@subsection PowerPC
12061
12062@table @code
12063
12064@kindex target dink32
12065@item target dink32 @var{dev}
12066DINK32 ROM monitor.
12067
12068@kindex target ppcbug
12069@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12070@kindex target ppcbug1
12071@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12072PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
12073
12074@kindex target sds
12075@item target sds @var{dev}
12076SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12077
12078@end table
12079
6d2ebf8b 12080@node PA
104c1213
JM
12081@subsection HP PA Embedded
12082
12083@table @code
12084
12085@kindex target op50n
12086@item target op50n @var{dev}
12087OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12088
12089@kindex target w89k
12090@item target w89k @var{dev}
12091W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
12092
12093@end table
12094
6d2ebf8b 12095@node SH
104c1213
JM
12096@subsection Hitachi SH
12097
12098@table @code
12099
d4f3574e 12100@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
12101@item target hms @var{dev}
12102A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12103commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12104the communications speed used.
12105
d4f3574e 12106@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
12107@item target e7000 @var{dev}
12108E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
12109
d4f3574e
SS
12110@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12111@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
12112@item target sh3 @var{dev}
12113@item target sh3e @var{dev}
12114Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
12115
12116@end table
12117
6d2ebf8b 12118@node Sparclet
104c1213
JM
12119@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
12120
12121@cindex Sparclet
12122
5d161b24
DB
12123@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12124Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
104c1213
JM
12125@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12126both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
5d161b24 12127@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
12128
12129@table @code
f0ca3dce 12130@item remotetimeout @var{args}
104c1213 12131@kindex remotetimeout
5d161b24
DB
12132@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12133This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12134seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
12135@end table
12136
41afff9a 12137@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
5d161b24 12138When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
d4f3574e 12139information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
5d161b24 12140load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
d4f3574e 12141@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
12142
12143@example
12144sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
12145@end example
12146
d4f3574e 12147You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
12148
12149@example
12150sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
12151@end example
12152
41afff9a 12153@cindex running, on Sparclet
104c1213
JM
12154Once you have set
12155your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
5d161b24 12156run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
12157(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
12158
12159@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12160
12161@example
12162(gdbslet)
12163@end example
12164
12165@menu
12166* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12167* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12168* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
5d161b24 12169* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12170@end menu
12171
6d2ebf8b 12172@node Sparclet File
104c1213
JM
12173@subsubsection Setting file to debug
12174
12175The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
12176
12177@example
12178(gdbslet) file prog
12179@end example
12180
12181@need 1000
12182@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12183@value{GDBN} locates
12184the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12185path.
12186If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12187files will be searched as well.
12188@value{GDBN} locates
12189the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12190path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12191If it fails
12192to find a file, it displays a message such as:
12193
12194@example
12195prog: No such file or directory.
12196@end example
12197
12198When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
5d161b24 12199the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
104c1213
JM
12200@code{target} command again.
12201
6d2ebf8b 12202@node Sparclet Connection
104c1213
JM
12203@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
12204
12205The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12206To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
12207
12208@example
12209(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12210Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
5d161b24 12211main () at ../prog.c:3
104c1213
JM
12212@end example
12213
12214@need 750
12215@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
12216
d4f3574e 12217@example
104c1213 12218Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 12219@end example
104c1213 12220
6d2ebf8b 12221@node Sparclet Download
104c1213
JM
12222@subsubsection Sparclet download
12223
12224@cindex download to Sparclet
5d161b24 12225Once connected to the Sparclet target,
104c1213
JM
12226you can use the @value{GDBN}
12227@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12228The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12229command.
5d161b24 12230Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 12231address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
12232offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12233of each of the file's sections.
12234For instance, if the program
12235@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12236and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12237
12238@example
12239(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12240Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12241@end example
12242
5d161b24
DB
12243If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12244to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
104c1213
JM
12245to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12246
6d2ebf8b 12247@node Sparclet Execution
104c1213
JM
12248@subsubsection Running and debugging
12249
12250@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12251You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
5d161b24 12252commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
12253manual for the list of commands.
12254
12255@example
12256(gdbslet) b main
12257Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
5d161b24 12258(gdbslet) run
104c1213
JM
12259Starting program: prog
12260Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
122613 char *symarg = 0;
12262(gdbslet) step
122634 char *execarg = "hello!";
5d161b24 12264(gdbslet)
104c1213
JM
12265@end example
12266
6d2ebf8b 12267@node Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12268@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12269
12270@table @code
12271
12272@kindex target sparclite
12273@item target sparclite @var{dev}
5d161b24
DB
12274Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12275You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12276For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
104c1213
JM
12277remote protocol.
12278
12279@end table
12280
6d2ebf8b 12281@node ST2000
104c1213
JM
12282@subsection Tandem ST2000
12283
2df3850c 12284@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
12285STDBUG protocol.
12286
12287To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12288manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12289
12290@example
12291target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12292@end example
12293
12294@noindent
12295to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12296the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12297ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12298connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12299concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12300
12301The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12302this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12303would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12304(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12305available on your host computer.
12306@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12307@c basically hearsay.
12308
12309@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12310These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12311environment:
12312
12313@table @code
12314@item st2000 @var{command}
12315@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12316@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12317@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12318Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12319manual for available commands.
12320
12321@item connect
12322@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12323Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12324you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12325sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12326@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12327@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12328@end table
12329
6d2ebf8b 12330@node Z8000
104c1213
JM
12331@subsection Zilog Z8000
12332
12333@cindex Z8000
12334@cindex simulator, Z8000
12335@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12336
12337When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12338a Z8000 simulator.
12339
12340For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12341unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12342segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12343appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12344
12345@table @code
12346@item target sim @var{args}
12347@kindex sim
d4f3574e 12348@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
12349Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12350options, specify them via @var{args}.
12351@end table
12352
12353@noindent
12354After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12355CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12356@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12357to run your program, and so on.
12358
d4f3574e
SS
12359As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12360(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12361additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12362
12363@table @code
12364
12365@item cycles
12366Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12367
12368@item insts
12369Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12370
12371@item time
12372Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12373
12374@end table
12375
12376You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12377conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12378conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12379simulated clock ticks.
12380
6d2ebf8b 12381@node Architectures
104c1213
JM
12382@section Architectures
12383
12384This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 12385all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
12386
12387@menu
12388* A29K::
12389* Alpha::
12390* MIPS::
12391@end menu
12392
6d2ebf8b 12393@node A29K
104c1213
JM
12394@subsection A29K
12395
12396@table @code
12397
12398@kindex set rstack_high_address
12399@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12400@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12401@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12402On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 12403@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
12404extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12405stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12406memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12407this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12408the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12409address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12410hexadecimal.
12411
12412@kindex show rstack_high_address
12413@item show rstack_high_address
12414Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12415processors.
12416
12417@end table
12418
6d2ebf8b 12419@node Alpha
104c1213
JM
12420@subsection Alpha
12421
12422See the following section.
12423
6d2ebf8b 12424@node MIPS
104c1213
JM
12425@subsection MIPS
12426
12427@cindex stack on Alpha
12428@cindex stack on MIPS
12429@cindex Alpha stack
12430@cindex MIPS stack
12431Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12432sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12433find the beginning of a function.
12434
12435@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12436To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12437@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12438you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12439commands:
12440
12441@table @code
00e4a2e4 12442@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
104c1213
JM
12443@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12444Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12445search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12446default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12447larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12448and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12449
12450@item show heuristic-fence-post
12451Display the current limit.
12452@end table
12453
12454@noindent
12455These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12456for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12457
12458
6d2ebf8b 12459@node Controlling GDB
c906108c
SS
12460@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12461
53a5351d
JM
12462You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12463@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 12464data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 12465described here.
c906108c
SS
12466
12467@menu
12468* Prompt:: Prompt
12469* Editing:: Command editing
12470* History:: Command history
12471* Screen Size:: Screen size
12472* Numbers:: Numbers
12473* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
5d161b24 12474* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
c906108c
SS
12475@end menu
12476
6d2ebf8b 12477@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
12478@section Prompt
12479
12480@cindex prompt
12481
12482@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12483called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12484can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12485instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
5d161b24 12486the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
c906108c
SS
12487which one you are talking to.
12488
d4f3574e 12489@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
12490prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12491or a prompt that does not.
12492
12493@table @code
12494@kindex set prompt
12495@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12496Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12497
12498@kindex show prompt
12499@item show prompt
12500Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12501@end table
12502
6d2ebf8b 12503@node Editing
c906108c
SS
12504@section Command editing
12505@cindex readline
12506@cindex command line editing
12507
12508@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12509@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12510command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12511or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12512substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12513debugging sessions.
12514
12515You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12516command @code{set}.
12517
12518@table @code
12519@kindex set editing
12520@cindex editing
12521@item set editing
12522@itemx set editing on
12523Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12524
12525@item set editing off
12526Disable command line editing.
12527
12528@kindex show editing
12529@item show editing
12530Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12531@end table
12532
6d2ebf8b 12533@node History
c906108c
SS
12534@section Command history
12535
12536@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12537debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12538happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12539history facility.
12540
12541@table @code
12542@cindex history substitution
12543@cindex history file
12544@kindex set history filename
12545@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12546@item set history filename @var{fname}
12547Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12548This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12549list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12550exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12551the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12552to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
12553@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12554is not set.
c906108c
SS
12555
12556@cindex history save
12557@kindex set history save
12558@item set history save
12559@itemx set history save on
12560Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12561@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12562
12563@item set history save off
12564Stop recording command history in a file.
12565
12566@cindex history size
12567@kindex set history size
12568@item set history size @var{size}
12569Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12570This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12571@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12572@end table
12573
12574@cindex history expansion
12575History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12576@ifset have-readline-appendices
12577@xref{Event Designators}.
12578@end ifset
12579
12580Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12581is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12582@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12583follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12584a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12585history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12586@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12587
12588The commands to control history expansion are:
12589
12590@table @code
12591@kindex set history expansion
12592@item set history expansion on
12593@itemx set history expansion
12594Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12595
12596@item set history expansion off
12597Disable history expansion.
12598
12599The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12600editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12601or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12602@ifset have-readline-appendices
12603@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12604@end ifset
12605
12606@c @group
12607@kindex show history
12608@item show history
12609@itemx show history filename
12610@itemx show history save
12611@itemx show history size
12612@itemx show history expansion
12613These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12614@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12615@c @end group
12616@end table
12617
12618@table @code
41afff9a 12619@kindex shows
c906108c
SS
12620@item show commands
12621Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12622
12623@item show commands @var{n}
12624Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12625
12626@item show commands +
12627Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12628@end table
12629
6d2ebf8b 12630@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
12631@section Screen size
12632@cindex size of screen
12633@cindex pauses in output
12634
12635Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12636information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12637@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12638output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12639to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12640determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12641printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12642rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12643
d4f3574e
SS
12644Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12645driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 12646together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 12647@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
12648you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12649width} commands:
12650
12651@table @code
12652@kindex set height
12653@kindex set width
12654@kindex show width
12655@kindex show height
12656@item set height @var{lpp}
12657@itemx show height
12658@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12659@itemx show width
12660These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12661a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12662commands display the current settings.
12663
5d161b24
DB
12664If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12665output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
c906108c
SS
12666file or to an editor buffer.
12667
12668Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12669from wrapping its output.
12670@end table
12671
6d2ebf8b 12672@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
12673@section Numbers
12674@cindex number representation
12675@cindex entering numbers
12676
2df3850c
JM
12677You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12678@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12679@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12680begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12681default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12682numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12683change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12684radix} command.
c906108c
SS
12685
12686@table @code
12687@kindex set input-radix
12688@item set input-radix @var{base}
12689Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12690for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12691specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12692example, any of
12693
12694@smallexample
12695set radix 012
12696set radix 10.
12697set radix 0xa
12698@end smallexample
12699
12700@noindent
12701sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12702leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12703
12704@kindex set output-radix
12705@item set output-radix @var{base}
12706Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12707for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12708specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12709
12710@kindex show input-radix
12711@item show input-radix
12712Display the current default base for numeric input.
12713
12714@kindex show output-radix
12715@item show output-radix
12716Display the current default base for numeric display.
12717@end table
12718
6d2ebf8b 12719@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
12720@section Optional warnings and messages
12721
2df3850c
JM
12722By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12723running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12724command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12725internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
12726
12727Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12728which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12729see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12730
12731@table @code
12732@kindex set verbose
12733@item set verbose on
12734Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12735
12736@item set verbose off
12737Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12738
12739@kindex show verbose
12740@item show verbose
12741Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12742@end table
12743
2df3850c
JM
12744By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12745object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12746find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12747symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
12748
12749@table @code
2df3850c 12750
c906108c
SS
12751@kindex set complaints
12752@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
12753Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12754unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12755@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12756to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
12757
12758@kindex show complaints
12759@item show complaints
12760Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 12761
c906108c
SS
12762@end table
12763
12764By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12765lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12766you try to run a program which is already running:
12767
12768@example
12769(@value{GDBP}) run
12770The program being debugged has been started already.
12771Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12772@end example
12773
12774If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12775commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12776
12777@table @code
2df3850c 12778
c906108c
SS
12779@kindex set confirm
12780@cindex flinching
12781@cindex confirmation
12782@cindex stupid questions
12783@item set confirm off
12784Disables confirmation requests.
12785
12786@item set confirm on
12787Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12788
12789@kindex show confirm
12790@item show confirm
12791Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 12792
c906108c
SS
12793@end table
12794
6d2ebf8b 12795@node Debugging Output
5d161b24
DB
12796@section Optional messages about internal happenings
12797@table @code
12798@kindex set debug arch
12799@item set debug arch
12800Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12801@kindex show debug arch
12802@item show debug arch
12803Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12804@kindex set debug event
12805@item set debug event
12806Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12807default is off.
12808@kindex show debug event
12809@item show debug event
12810Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12811info.
12812@kindex set debug expression
12813@item set debug expression
12814Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12815default is off.
12816@kindex show debug expression
12817@item show debug expression
12818Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12819debugging info.
12820@kindex set debug overload
12821@item set debug overload
b37052ae 12822Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
5d161b24
DB
12823info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12824is off.
12825@kindex show debug overload
12826@item show debug overload
b37052ae 12827Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
5d161b24
DB
12828debugging info.
12829@kindex set debug remote
12830@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12831@cindex serial connections, debugging
12832@item set debug remote
12833Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12834the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12835@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12836@kindex show debug remote
12837@item show debug remote
12838Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12839@kindex set debug serial
12840@item set debug serial
12841Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12842default is off.
12843@kindex show debug serial
12844@item show debug serial
12845Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12846info.
12847@kindex set debug target
12848@item set debug target
12849Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12850includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12851default is off.
12852@kindex show debug target
12853@item show debug target
12854Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12855info.
12856@kindex set debug varobj
12857@item set debug varobj
12858Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12859info. The default is off.
12860@kindex show debug varobj
12861@item show debug varobj
12862Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12863debugging info.
12864@end table
12865
6d2ebf8b 12866@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
12867@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
12868
12869Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
12870command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12871commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12872files.
c906108c
SS
12873
12874@menu
12875* Define:: User-defined commands
12876* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12877* Command Files:: Command files
12878* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12879@end menu
12880
6d2ebf8b 12881@node Define
c906108c
SS
12882@section User-defined commands
12883
12884@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
12885A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12886which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12887@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12888separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12889via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
12890
12891@smallexample
12892define adder
12893 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12894@end smallexample
12895
d4f3574e
SS
12896@noindent
12897To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
12898
12899@smallexample
12900adder 1 2 3
12901@end smallexample
12902
d4f3574e
SS
12903@noindent
12904This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
5d161b24 12905its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
c906108c
SS
12906reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12907functions calls.
12908
12909@table @code
2df3850c 12910
c906108c
SS
12911@kindex define
12912@item define @var{commandname}
12913Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12914by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
12915
12916The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12917which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12918commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12919
12920@kindex if
12921@kindex else
12922@item if
12923Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12924It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12925only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12926There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12927by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12928was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12929
12930@kindex while
12931@item while
12932The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12933which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12934execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12935The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12936evaluates to true.
12937
12938@kindex document
12939@item document @var{commandname}
12940Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
5d161b24
DB
12941accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12942defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12943reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12944After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
c906108c
SS
12945@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
12946
12947You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12948documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12949does not change the documentation.
12950
12951@kindex help user-defined
12952@item help user-defined
12953List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12954(if any) for each.
12955
12956@kindex show user
12957@item show user
12958@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
12959Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12960not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 12961definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 12962
c906108c
SS
12963@end table
12964
12965When user-defined commands are executed, the
12966commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12967stops execution of the user-defined command.
12968
12969If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
5d161b24
DB
12970without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12971commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
c906108c
SS
12972messages when used in a user-defined command.
12973
6d2ebf8b 12974@node Hooks
c906108c 12975@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
12976@cindex command hooks
12977@cindex hooks, for commands
c78b4128 12978@cindex hooks, pre-command
c906108c 12979
c78b4128
EZ
12980@kindex hook
12981@kindex hook-
12982You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
c906108c
SS
12983command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12984command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12985before that command.
12986
c78b4128
EZ
12987@cindex hooks, post-command
12988@kindex hookpost
12989@kindex hookpost-
12990A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12991Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12992@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12993that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12994pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12995
12996It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12997occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12998
12999@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
13000@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
13001
d4f3574e 13002@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
13003In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
13004(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
13005execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
13006displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
13007
c906108c
SS
13008For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
13009single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
13010you could define:
13011
13012@example
13013define hook-stop
13014handle SIGALRM nopass
13015end
13016
13017define hook-run
13018handle SIGALRM pass
13019end
13020
13021define hook-continue
13022handle SIGLARM pass
13023end
13024@end example
c906108c 13025
c78b4128
EZ
13026As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13027command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13028you could define:
13029
13030@example
13031define hook-echo
13032echo <<<---
13033end
13034
13035define hookpost-echo
13036echo --->>>\n
13037end
13038
13039(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13040<<<---Hello World--->>>
13041(@value{GDBP})
13042
13043@end example
13044
c906108c
SS
13045You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13046not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13047name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13048@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13049@c or not?
13050If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13051@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13052(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
13053
13054If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13055get a warning from the @code{define} command.
13056
6d2ebf8b 13057@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
13058@section Command files
13059
13060@cindex command files
5d161b24
DB
13061A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13062commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13063An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
c906108c
SS
13064the last command, as it would from the terminal.
13065
13066@cindex init file
13067@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 13068@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c 13069When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
2a3d5645
CF
13070@dfn{init files}. These files are normally named @file{.gdbinit} although
13071filename limitations require that they be named @file{gdb.ini} on MS-DOS.
13072During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
bf0184be
ND
13073following:
13074
13075@enumerate
13076@item
13077Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13078DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13079@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
13080
13081@item
13082Processes command line options and operands.
13083
13084@item
13085Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
13086
13087@item
13088Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13089@end enumerate
13090
13091The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13092complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13093and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13094option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 13095
c906108c
SS
13096@cindex init file name
13097On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13098different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13099form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13100different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13101environments with special init file names:
13102
00e4a2e4 13103@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c
SS
13104@itemize @bullet
13105@item
00e4a2e4 13106VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 13107
00e4a2e4 13108@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13109@item
00e4a2e4 13110OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13111
00e4a2e4 13112@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 13113@item
00e4a2e4 13114ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 13115@end itemize
c906108c
SS
13116
13117You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13118@code{source} command:
13119
13120@table @code
13121@kindex source
13122@item source @var{filename}
13123Execute the command file @var{filename}.
13124@end table
13125
13126The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
13127printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
13128of the command file.
13129
13130Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13131without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13132normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13133when called from command files.
13134
b433d00b
DH
13135@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13136mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13137standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13138not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13139the next command.
13140
13141@example
13142gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
13143@end example
13144
13145(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13146will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13147would be directed to @file{log}.
13148
6d2ebf8b 13149@node Output
c906108c
SS
13150@section Commands for controlled output
13151
13152During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13153@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13154explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13155describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13156want.
13157
13158@table @code
13159@kindex echo
13160@item echo @var{text}
13161@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13162@c because it is not in ANSI.
13163Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13164@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13165newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13166In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13167by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13168string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
5d161b24 13169trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
c906108c
SS
13170To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13171@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
13172
13173A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13174the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
13175
13176@example
13177echo This is some text\n\
13178which is continued\n\
13179onto several lines.\n
13180@end example
13181
13182produces the same output as
13183
13184@example
13185echo This is some text\n
13186echo which is continued\n
13187echo onto several lines.\n
13188@end example
13189
13190@kindex output
13191@item output @var{expression}
13192Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13193newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
5d161b24 13194value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
c906108c
SS
13195on expressions.
13196
13197@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13198Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13199the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13200formats}, for more information.
13201
13202@kindex printf
13203@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13204Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13205@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13206either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13207@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13208subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
13209@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13210@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13211@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13212@c supported.
c906108c
SS
13213
13214@example
13215printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
13216@end example
13217
13218For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
13219
13220@smallexample
13221printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13222@end smallexample
13223
13224The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13225string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13226letter.
13227@end table
13228
c4555f82
SC
13229@node TUI
13230@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13231@cindex TUI
13232
13233@menu
13234* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13235* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
13236* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13237* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13238@end menu
13239
13240The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13241is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13242to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13243and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13244The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13245with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
13246
13247@node TUI Overview
13248@section TUI overview
13249
13250The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13251@value{GDBN} runs:
13252
13253@itemize @bullet
13254@item
13255A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13256windows on the terminal.
13257
13258@item
13259A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13260the TUI.
13261@end itemize
13262
13263In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13264on the terminal:
13265
13266@table @emph
13267@item command
13268This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13269prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13270managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13271window is always visible.
13272
13273@item source
13274The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13275line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
13276The current program position is shown with the @samp{>} marker and
13277active breakpoints are shown with @samp{*} markers.
13278
13279@item assembly
13280The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
13281
13282@item register
13283This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13284a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13285changed are highlighted.
13286
13287@end table
13288
13289The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13290and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13291changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13292These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13293layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13294The following layouts are available:
13295
13296@itemize @bullet
13297@item
13298source
13299
13300@item
13301assembly
13302
13303@item
13304source and assembly
13305
13306@item
13307source and registers
13308
13309@item
13310assembly and registers
13311
13312@end itemize
13313
13314@node TUI Keys
13315@section TUI Key Bindings
13316@cindex TUI key bindings
13317
13318The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13319(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13320They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
13321directly on the TUI layout and windows. The following key bindings
13322are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
13323
13324@table @kbd
13325@kindex C-x C-a
13326@item C-x C-a
13327@kindex C-x a
13328@itemx C-x a
13329@kindex C-x A
13330@itemx C-x A
13331Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13332the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13333its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13334mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13335The screen is then refreshed.
13336
13337@kindex C-x 1
13338@item C-x 1
13339Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13340either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13341is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
13342
13343Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
13344
13345@kindex C-x 2
13346@item C-x 2
13347Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13348layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13349When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13350previous layout and the new one.
13351
13352Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
13353
13354@end table
13355
13356The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
13357
13358@table @key
13359@kindex PgUp
13360@item PgUp
13361Scroll the active window one page up.
13362
13363@kindex PgDn
13364@item PgDn
13365Scroll the active window one page down.
13366
13367@kindex Up
13368@item Up
13369Scroll the active window one line up.
13370
13371@kindex Down
13372@item Down
13373Scroll the active window one line down.
13374
13375@kindex Left
13376@item Left
13377Scroll the active window one column left.
13378
13379@kindex Right
13380@item Right
13381Scroll the active window one column right.
13382
13383@kindex C-L
13384@item C-L
13385Refresh the screen.
13386
13387@end table
13388
13389In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13390for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13391necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13392@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13393
13394@node TUI Commands
13395@section TUI specific commands
13396@cindex TUI commands
13397
13398The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13399These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13400the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13401is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13402in the TUI mode.
13403
13404@table @code
13405@item layout next
13406@kindex layout next
13407Display the next layout.
13408
13409@item layout prev
13410@kindex layout prev
13411Display the previous layout.
13412
13413@item layout src
13414@kindex layout src
13415Display the source window only.
13416
13417@item layout asm
13418@kindex layout asm
13419Display the assembly window only.
13420
13421@item layout split
13422@kindex layout split
13423Display the source and assembly window.
13424
13425@item layout regs
13426@kindex layout regs
13427Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13428
13429@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13430@kindex focus
13431Set the focus to the named window.
13432This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13433can be affected to another window.
13434
13435@item refresh
13436@kindex refresh
13437Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
13438
13439@item update
13440@kindex update
13441Update the source window and the current execution point.
13442
13443@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13444@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13445@kindex winheight
13446Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13447lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13448decrease it.
13449
13450@end table
13451
13452@node TUI Configuration
13453@section TUI configuration variables
13454@cindex TUI configuration variables
13455
13456The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13457appearance of windows on the terminal.
13458
13459@table @code
732b3002
SC
13460@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13461@kindex set tui border-kind
c4555f82
SC
13462Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13463The possible values are the following:
13464@table @code
13465@item space
13466Use a space character to draw the border.
13467
13468@item ascii
13469Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
13470
13471@item acs
13472Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13473drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
13474
13475@end table
13476
732b3002
SC
13477@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13478@kindex set tui active-border-mode
c4555f82
SC
13479Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13480The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13481@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
13482
732b3002
SC
13483@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13484@kindex set tui border-mode
c4555f82
SC
13485Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13486The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13487@table @code
13488@item normal
13489Use normal attributes to display the border.
13490
13491@item standout
13492Use standout mode.
13493
13494@item reverse
13495Use reverse video mode.
13496
13497@item half
13498Use half bright mode.
13499
13500@item half-standout
13501Use half bright and standout mode.
13502
13503@item bold
13504Use extra bright or bold mode.
13505
13506@item bold-standout
13507Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
13508
13509@end table
13510
13511@end table
13512
6d2ebf8b 13513@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
13514@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
13515
13516@cindex Emacs
13517@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13518A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13519edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13520@value{GDBN}.
13521
13522To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13523executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13524@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13525created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 13526@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
13527
13528Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13529things:
13530
13531@itemize @bullet
13532@item
13533All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13534@end itemize
13535
13536This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13537and output done by the program you are debugging.
13538
13539This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13540commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13541in this way.
13542
13543All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13544with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13545way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13546stop.
13547
13548@itemize @bullet
13549@item
13550@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13551@end itemize
13552
13553Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13554source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13555left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13556source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13557and the source.
13558
13559Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13560usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
13561
13562@quotation
13563@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13564current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13565the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13566appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13567environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13568session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13569back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13570avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13571your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13572@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
13573
13574A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13575switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13576@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13577@end quotation
13578
13579By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13580you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13581several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13582Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13583
13584@example
13585(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13586@end example
13587
13588@noindent
d4f3574e 13589(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
13590in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13591``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13592
13593In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13594addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13595
13596@table @kbd
13597@item C-h m
13598Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13599
13600@item M-s
13601Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13602update the display window to show the current file and location.
13603
13604@item M-n
13605Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13606calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13607to show the current file and location.
13608
13609@item M-i
13610Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13611display window accordingly.
13612
13613@item M-x gdb-nexti
13614Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13615display window accordingly.
13616
13617@item C-c C-f
13618Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13619@code{finish} command.
13620
13621@item M-c
13622Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13623command.
13624
13625@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13626
13627@item M-u
13628Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13629(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13630like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13631
13632@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13633
13634@item M-d
13635Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13636@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13637
13638@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13639
13640@item C-x &
13641Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13642of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13643around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13644then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13645argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13646
13647You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13648@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13649otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13650inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13651wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13652list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13653formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13654is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13655@end table
13656
13657In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13658tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13659
13660If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13661it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13662request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13663the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13664frame.
13665
13666The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13667which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13668the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13669communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13670delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13671to correspond properly with the code.
13672
13673@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13674@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13675@ignore
13676@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13677@kindex Epoch
13678@kindex inspect
13679
5d161b24 13680Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
c906108c
SS
13681called the @code{epoch}
13682environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13683@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13684each value is printed in its own window.
13685@end ignore
c906108c 13686
d700128c 13687@include annotate.texi
7162c0ca 13688@include gdbmi.texinfo
d700128c 13689
6d2ebf8b 13690@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
13691@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13692@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13693@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
13694
13695Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
13696
13697Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13698may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13699the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13700reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
13701
13702In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13703information that enables us to fix the bug.
13704
13705@menu
13706* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13707* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
13708@end menu
13709
6d2ebf8b 13710@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
13711@section Have you found a bug?
13712@cindex bug criteria
13713
13714If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
13715
13716@itemize @bullet
13717@cindex fatal signal
13718@cindex debugger crash
13719@cindex crash of debugger
13720@item
13721If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13722@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13723
13724@cindex error on valid input
13725@item
13726If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13727bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13728somewhere in the connection to the target.)
13729
13730@cindex invalid input
13731@item
13732If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13733that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13734``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13735for traditional practice''.
13736
13737@item
13738If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13739for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
13740@end itemize
13741
6d2ebf8b 13742@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
13743@section How to report bugs
13744@cindex bug reports
13745@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13746
c906108c
SS
13747A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13748If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13749contact that organization first.
13750
13751You can find contact information for many support companies and
13752individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13753distribution.
13754@c should add a web page ref...
13755
13756In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
13757@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
13758
13759@example
d4f3574e 13760bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
13761@end example
13762
13763@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 13764@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
13765not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13766@samp{bug-gdb}.
13767
13768The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13769serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13770the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13771newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13772problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13773path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13774we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13775bug reports to the mailing list.
13776
13777As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
13778
13779@example
13780@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
13781Free Software Foundation Inc.
1378259 Temple Place - Suite 330
13783Boston, MA 02111-1307
13784USA
13785@end example
c906108c
SS
13786
13787The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13788@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13789fact or leave it out, state it!
13790
13791Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13792problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13793assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13794Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13795stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13796name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13797of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13798the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13799easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
13800
13801Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13802bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13803you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13804self-contained.
13805
13806Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13807bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13808@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13809bugs properly.
13810
13811To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
13812
13813@itemize @bullet
13814@item
13815The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13816with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13817version}.
13818
13819Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13820the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
13821
13822@item
13823The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13824version number.
13825
c906108c
SS
13826@item
13827What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13828``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
13829
13830@item
13831What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13832debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13833C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13834information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13835compilers.
13836
13837@item
13838The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13839observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13840you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13841Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
13842
13843If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13844and then we might not encounter the bug.
13845
13846@item
13847A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13848reproduce the bug.
13849
13850@item
13851A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13852incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
13853
13854Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13855will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13856not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13857a chance to make a mistake.
13858
13859Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13860say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13861copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13862the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13863crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13864ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13865us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13866to draw any conclusion from our observations.
13867
c906108c
SS
13868@item
13869If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13870diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13871it by context, not by line number.
13872
13873The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13874sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 13875
c906108c
SS
13876@end itemize
13877
13878Here are some things that are not necessary:
13879
13880@itemize @bullet
13881@item
13882A description of the envelope of the bug.
13883
13884Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13885which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13886changes will not affect it.
13887
13888This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13889will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13890with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13891We recommend that you save your time for something else.
13892
13893Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13894of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13895output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13896less time, and so on.
13897
13898However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13899report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
13900
13901@item
13902A patch for the bug.
13903
13904A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13905the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13906a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13907to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
13908
13909Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13910construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13911through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13912to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
13913
13914And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13915patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13916help us to understand.
13917
13918@item
13919A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
13920
13921Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13922things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13923@end itemize
13924
5d161b24 13925@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
c906108c
SS
13926@c and consists of the two following files:
13927@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13928@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13929@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13930@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13931@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13932@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13933
13934
6d2ebf8b 13935@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
13936@appendix Formatting Documentation
13937
13938@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13939@cindex reference card
13940The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13941for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13942subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13943@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13944release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13945you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
13946
13947The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13948can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
13949
13950@example
13951make refcard.dvi
13952@end example
13953
5d161b24
DB
13954The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13955mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
c906108c
SS
13956that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13957high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13958your @sc{dvi} output program.
13959
13960@cindex documentation
13961
13962All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13963distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13964a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13965on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13966formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13967and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
13968
13969@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13970version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13971file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13972subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13973necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13974but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13975Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13976@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
13977
13978If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13979Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13980@code{makeinfo}.
13981
13982If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13983@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13984version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
13985
13986@example
13987cd gdb
13988make gdb.info
13989@end example
13990
13991If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13992a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13993Texinfo definitions file.
13994
13995@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13996produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13997document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13998has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13999command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
14000(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
14001require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
14002
14003@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
14004@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
14005written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
14006typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
14007and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
14008directory.
14009
14010If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
14011typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
14012subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
14013@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
14014
14015@example
14016make gdb.dvi
14017@end example
14018
14019Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 14020
6d2ebf8b 14021@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
14022@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14023@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14024@cindex installation
14025
c906108c
SS
14026@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14027of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14028build the @code{gdb} program.
14029@iftex
14030@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14031@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14032look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14033installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14034@end iftex
14035
5d161b24
DB
14036The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14037@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
c906108c
SS
14038appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
14039
14040For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14041@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
14042
14043@table @code
14044@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14045script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
14046
14047@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14048the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
14049
14050@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14051source for the Binary File Descriptor library
14052
14053@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14054@sc{gnu} include files
14055
14056@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14057source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
14058
14059@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14060source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
14061
14062@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14063source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
14064
14065@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14066source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
14067
14068@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14069source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14070@end table
14071
14072The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14073from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14074this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
14075
14076First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14077if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14078identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14079argument.
14080
14081For example:
14082
14083@example
14084cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14085./configure @var{host}
14086make
14087@end example
14088
14089@noindent
14090where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14091@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14092(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14093correct value by examining your system.)
14094
14095Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14096@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14097libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14098binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
14099
14100@need 750
14101@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14102system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14103shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
14104
14105@example
14106sh configure @var{host}
14107@end example
14108
14109If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14110directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14111@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14112creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14113you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14114
14115You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
14116subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
14117configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
14118
14119For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
14120the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
14121
14122@example
14123@group
14124cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14125../configure @var{host}
14126@end group
14127@end example
14128
14129You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14130However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14131the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14132that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14133let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
14134
14135@menu
14136* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14137* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14138* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14139@end menu
14140
6d2ebf8b 14141@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
14142@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14143
14144If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14145you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14146host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14147allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14148rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14149handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14150@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14151program specified there.
14152
14153To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14154with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14155(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14156itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14157would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14158the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
14159
5d161b24 14160For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
c906108c
SS
14161separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
14162
14163@example
14164@group
14165cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14166mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14167cd ../gdb-sun4
14168../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14169make
14170@end group
14171@end example
14172
14173When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14174directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14175(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14176the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14177directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14178@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
14179
14180One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
5d161b24
DB
14181directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14182@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14183programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
c906108c
SS
14184You specify a cross-debugging target by
14185giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
14186
14187When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14188it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14189called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
14190
14191The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14192directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14193directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14194directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14195will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
14196
14197When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14198directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14199if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14200with each other.
14201
6d2ebf8b 14202@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
14203@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
14204
14205The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14206script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14207aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14208of information in the following pattern:
14209
14210@example
14211@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
14212@end example
14213
14214For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14215or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14216option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
14217
14218The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14219any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14220aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14221@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14222script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14223abbreviations---for example:
14224
14225@smallexample
14226% sh config.sub i386-linux
14227i386-pc-linux-gnu
14228% sh config.sub alpha-linux
14229alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14230% sh config.sub hp9k700
14231hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14232% sh config.sub sun4
14233sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14234% sh config.sub sun3
14235m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14236% sh config.sub i986v
14237Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14238@end smallexample
14239
14240@noindent
14241@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14242directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
14243
6d2ebf8b 14244@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
14245@section @code{configure} options
14246
14247Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14248are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14249several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14250Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
14251
14252@example
14253configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14254 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14255 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14256 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14257 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14258 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14259 @var{host}
14260@end example
14261
14262@noindent
14263You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14264@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14265@samp{--}.
14266
14267@table @code
14268@item --help
14269Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
14270
14271@item --prefix=@var{dir}
14272Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14273@file{@var{dir}}.
14274
14275@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14276Configure the source to install programs under directory
14277@file{@var{dir}}.
14278
14279@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14280@need 2000
14281@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14282@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14283@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14284Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14285@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14286build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14287directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14288the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14289directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14290the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14291@var{dirname}.
14292
14293@item --norecursion
14294Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14295propagate configuration to subdirectories.
14296
14297@item --target=@var{target}
14298Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14299@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14300programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
14301
14302There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
14303
14304@item @var{host} @dots{}
14305Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
14306
14307There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14308@end table
14309
14310There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14311needed for special purposes only.
5d161b24 14312
6d2ebf8b 14313@node Index
c906108c
SS
14314@unnumbered Index
14315
14316@printindex cp
14317
14318@tex
14319% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
14320% meantime:
14321\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
14322\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
14323\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
14324\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
14325\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
14326\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
14327\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
14328\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
14329\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
14330\page\colophon
14331% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
14332@end tex
14333
449f3b6c
AC
14334@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
14335@ifinfo
c906108c 14336@contents
449f3b6c
AC
14337@end ifinfo
14338@ifhtml
14339@contents
14340@end ifhtml
14341
c906108c 14342@bye
This page took 0.886053 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.